Surgery
Surgery
Surgery
Preface - 8
Introduction - 10
Otology - 29
Mastoidectomy an introduction - 29
Tympanomastoidectomy - 46
Drilling tips - 60
Canalplasty - 61
Otoendoscopy - 64
Endoscopic myringoplasty - 66
Classic myringoplasty - 72
Tympanoplasty - 74
Grommet insertion - 88
Stapedectomy - 94
2
Preauricular sinus excision - 104
Labyrinthectomy - 111
Meatoplasty - 116
Rhinology - 132
History - 132
Maxillectomy - 142
FESS - 209
TESPAL - 230
Use of Foley’s catheter in the management of fracture anterior wall of maxilla - 278
Laryngology - 338
Tonsillectomy - 338
Adenoidectomy - 344
Tracheostomy - 354
Diathermy - 499
Lasers - 508
Diathermy - 596
This book will help in training the post graduates not only the basic surgical skills but also in ad-
vanced surgical techniques in otolaryngology.
8
About the Author
Professor Dr Balasubramanian Thiagarajan was formerly professor and Head Department of Oto-
laryngology Stanley Medical College, Registrar The Tamilnadu Dr MGR Medical University. He is
a devoted teacher with rich academic experience. He has authored many books in otolaryngology.
He is also running websites for the benefit of students of otolaryngology.
Android apps for the benefit of students have been developed by him.
Android apps:
1. drtbalu’s ENT (Post graduate resource) can be downloaded from android app store.
2. Imaging in Rhinology
3. ENT Instruments
4. ENT Resources
10
The early compound microscopes were very the observer’s eye. The body of the case can be
inefficient and the quality of the image was very used as a live box for storing specimen.
poor. During the first decade of the 17th centu-
ry large compound microscopes were designed. 18th century was a period of mechanical de-
The term microscope was used by Giovanni velopment of microscope. A screw barrel was
Faber4 of Germany. He was a botanist and art added to the basic design to improve focusing
collector. and superior magnification. The final form of
the microscope was established design wise.
Leeuwenhoek’s simple microscope: One basic problem existed in these microscopes
(chromatic aberration). This occurred because
Dutch surveyor Antoni van Leeuwenhoek in of different wavelengths making up the white
1673 used molten glass balls to form lenses light. Light waves of differing wave lengths are
and build crude simple microscopes that could bent at different angles by the convex lens to
magnify up to 275 times. One of the first things form this aberration. This aberration results
he examined under his new microscope was the in the formation of a series of strongly colored
scab from his own nose. fringe rings. This was overcome by design
modifications and by increasing the working
distance from the specimen.
12
Zeiss OPMI 1 Model (1951):
Stereoscopic 3 D vision:
14
Historical aspects of Otolaryngological Surgery
16
tion of mucosal dryness due to enlargement of improve the drainage. In 1898 Riedel performed
the volume of nasal cavity. obliteration of frontal sinus. He advocated com-
Hence the term “ethmoidectomy” indicated an plete removal of anterior table and floor of frontal
opening restricted to few ethmoidal cells while sinus with stripping of mucosa. He performed
the term “total ethmoidectomy” included open- this procedure in a patient with osteomyelitis of
ing off sphenoid and maxillary sinuses as well. frontal bone. This procedure caused an unsight-
ly deformity of skull. Killian in 1903 advocated
The first approach to frontal sinus was derived retention of 1 cm bar of supraorbital rim. Killian
from ophthalmology. Alexander Ogston a Scot- was able to avoid deformity by retaining this bar
tish ophthalmologist managed to reach frontal si- of bone. Killian also advocated ethmoidectomy
nus via a horizontal incision performed under the combined with rotation of mucosal flap to cover
eyebrow and drilling the bone thereby creating the frontal recess area. Killian’s procedure was
a breach sufficiently wide to allow the opening fraught with complications like Restenosis, supra-
of both frontal sinuses. This technique was then orbital rim necrosis, post op meningitis, muco-
described in 1894 by Luc, who used it to insert a cele formation etc.
drainage tube into the frontal sinus. This surgery
was known as Ogston-Luc procedure. Era of conservative procedures (1905):
18
as the Messerklinger’s technique of endoscopic He developed the concept of major sinuses like
sinus surgery. frontal and maxillary sinuses were dependent
sinuses. Their drainage depended on a clear
anterior ethmoid cell structures in the middle
meatus. This zone was later christened as the
‘Osteomeatal unit’ by Naumann. This concept
was further popularized by David Kennedy of
United States.
Walter Messerklinger
David Kennedy (ENT Resident) at Johns Hop- 1. Era of trepan (18th century)
kins Medical School Baltimore was asked to
review the paper published by Messerklinger 2. Era of chisel & gouge (Early 19th century)
titled “ Endoscopy of the nose”. He became so
enthused that he made it a point to learn the 3. Era of electrical drill (20th century)
technique himself. David Kennedy along with
Stamberger popularized Messerklinger technique Era of Trepan:
all over the English-speaking world.
Trephination was performed to let out pus. This
Endoscopic sinus surgery initially was performed was extensively practiced during the 18th century
with a Wittosmer side arm attached to a beam to let out pus from skull bones. The first success-
splitter placed on the eyepiece of the telescope ful trephination of mastoid cavity was performed
so that the observer could view the surgery. The by Ambroise Pare during 16th century. Young-
observer usually stood on the opposite side of the er during 17th century devised a hand Trepan
table and would support the bulky side arm with which he used extensively to perform this pro-
20
cedure. A handheld trepan was commonly used
during this period. The cutting head of trepan Modern mastoid surgery was pioneered by the
used could be circular (to cut a circular piece of German otologist Scwartze during 1873. He and
bone), exfoliative head (to shed the superficial his assistant Adolf Eysell abandoned the use of
layer of bone), and perforative head (used to Trepan in favor of chisel and gouge. He popu-
make a hole in the bone). In 1736 Jean Louis larized Chisel and gouge as he was convinced
Petit performed the first mastoid opening for a that it was the safest way to open up the mastoid
patient with mastoid abscess. Pus His main aim antrum. His assistant had drawn up detailed
was to create a hole through which pus from the illustrations of the various types of chisel and
mastoid cavity can drain. While using a Trepan gouges used in this procedure. Buck introduced
it should be dipped in cold water often to reduce the small curette that could be used to widen the
heat generated during the procedure. aditus. He also advocated continuous chiseling
of the hard mastoid cortex till the soft bone is
In 1776 Jasser used a trocar to open up the reached which could be curetted out rather easily
mastoid cavity. He used the nozzle of a syringe using curettes of varying sizes.
to aspirate the contents from the mastoid cavity.
This surgical procedure hence was aptly named Initially Volkmann sharp edged spoons were
as “Jasser procedure”. The term “trocar” has its used as curette. Samuel Kopetzky, American
origin in French language. “Toris – quarts” is otologist advised that one should become dex-
a French word to describe an instrument with terous and elegant with the use of a set of instru-
three cutting sides used to make a hole. Amer- ments. Newer instruments (design wise) should
ican otologist Fredreik White described this era be introduced only when they have distinct
of mastoid surgery as an experimental one. This advantages over the tried out older ones. This
experimental era proved that the concept of observation holds good even today.
opening up the mastoid cavity and draining the
secretions is a possibility. The instrumentation Electrically driven drill period: “Modern era
was of course woefully inadequate. The first Mastoidectomy”
catalogue of surgical instruments published in
1860’s mentioned the various surgical and dental Electrically driven drills were used to manage
instruments in use. Mastoid instrumentation of dental caries even way back in 1882. It was
course did not find a place in that catalogue. William McEwen who drew the attention of the
world to this unique device. He believed that
Chisel & Gouge period: the safest instrument that can be used to drill the
mastoid antrum is the rotating burr. It had better
This period was characterized by the introduc- control and uniform rotator cutting ability. The
tion of general anesthesia which facilitated a size of the burr bits can vary according to the
surgeon to operate leisurely on a patient. It was area of surgery. It was Julius Lempert in 1922
Amedee Forget a French surgeon who used a who really popularized the use of electrically
mallet and gouge to open the mastoid cavity and driven drill in ear surgeries. William House
drain the accumulated pus. He performed this introduced the suction irrigation system and
surgery during 1860. retractors in mastoid surgery. He observed that
22
Role of Microdebriders in Otolaryngology
Introduction:
The originally patented Vacuum dissector was
Microdebrider should be considered to be next cylindrical, electrically powered shaver system
only to an endoscope in rhinological surgical which is supplied with continuous suction. The
procedures. It is hence considered to be the most basic design which was patented has a hollow
important innovations in shaft with a rotating / oscillating inner cannula.
the field of rhinology and endoscopic sinus sur- The suction applied draws the soft tissue in-
gery. In recent times this instrument is becoming wards and is trapped there. This trapped tissue
really popular thereby reducing the reliance on is sheared off by the rotating blade between the
traditional non powered inner and outer cannulas.
sinus instruments like curettes and forceps. The slower the rotating speed of the blade larger
is the tissue bite, at higher speed rates the instru-
Advantages of Microdebrider include: ment becomes less aggressive. The sheared bits of
tissue are sucked by the suction effect. Irrigation
1. It spares the adjacent mucosa (Mucosal spar- via a side portal is performed in a continuous
ing) basis.
2. It is precise
3. Removes tissue real fast Irrigation helps in preventing the bits of tissue
4. Visualization is really good from blocking the suction portal of the hand
5. Since the blade comes in different angles it can piece. The bits of tissue sheared by debrider blade
be used to cut tissues from can be collected and sent for histopathological
even inaccessible areas inside the nose examination also.
6. The suction applied to the blade sucks and
holds the tissue for better cutting Hand piece design:
effect
All the commonly used debrider hand-pieces still
History: maintain the cylindrical design of the original
patent of Urban. The cylindrical design permits
Originally the concept and design of Microde- the surgeon to hold the hand piece as if it were a
brider was patented by Urban in 1969. scalpel.
In his patent application he called the equipment
“Vacuum rotatory dissector”. This equipment was The Diego Microdebrider provides a pistol grip
originally used by the House group to remove hand-piece. Some surgeons find this comfortable.
acoustic neuroma during 1970’s. Orthopedic sur-
geons started using it for arthroscopic surgeries With the image guidance systems becoming
from the year 1975. common hand-piece manufacturers have made
hand pieces that can be easily coupled with image
It was only from the year 1994 Setliff and Parsons guidance system.
started using this equipment for nasal surgeries.
Improvements to this original vacuum dissector
started taking place by leaps and bounds.
24
These blades can either be set to oscillate or Tonsillectomy blades:
rotate. Oscillation usually runs at a slow speed
(5000 rpm) and is useful for soft tissue resection. These blades are used to perform extra capsular
At slower speeds the port remains open longer tonsillectomy. These blades are wider with low
allowing more soft tissue to be drawn into the angles to enable it to function as a guillotine.
aperture before the cut could be made. This adds These blades usually come in 4mm diameters.
to the efficiency of soft tissue resection.
Adenoidectomy blades:
Forward and reverse rotations are faster (up
to 15,000 rpm) and has a drill like action and These blades are curved and hence can be intro-
hence could be used to drill bony structures as duced through the nasal cavities. The curvature
in endoscopic dcr, reduction of bony septal spur of these blades mimics the curvature of the nasal
etc. Since the speed is too low for drilling bony cavity.
structures when compared to the mastoid micro-
drills, it takes a long time to drill bony structures
using a Microdebrider. Recent innovations in
Microdebrider blades is the availability of blades
which are prebent to suit the various angulations
of resection inside the nasal cavity.
Turbinectomy blades:
Role of debriders in clearing up the operating
These blades are used to perform inferior turbi- field:
nectomy. These blades are small diameter blades
(2-2.8 mm). It has a beveled guard at the back Clearing the operating field of blood and other
which protects the turbinate mucosa while the secretions is a must for better visibility during
vascular erectile tissue is being dissected. This nasal endoscopic sinus surgery. Even small
mucosal protection causes lower incidence of amounts of bleeding can significantly impair
osteitis of the inferior concha. visibility during endoscopic surgeries. Debriders
have the ability to continuously suck blood and
Turbinectomy blades: dissected tissues out of the surgical field is a great
advantage.
These blades are used to perform inferior turbi-
nectomy. These blades are small diameter blades Recent modifications in debrider technology
(2-2.8 mm). It has a beveled guard at the back have managed to add the ability to cauterize
which protects the turbinate mucosa while the bleeders using bipolar cautery delivered via the
vascular erectile tissue is being dissected. This end of the blade. These blades themselves are sur-
mucosal protection causes lower incidence of rounded by layers of insulation causing a sand-
osteitis of the inferior concha. wiching of the inner and outer electrodes. These
instruments can be set to cauterize bleeders in
three settings:
1. Low – 10 Watts
2. Medium – 20 Watts
3. High – 40 Watts
26
The only drawback of these blades is that only a Where do you use Microdebrider drill bits?
small zone of bipolar cautery is present.
1. In Endoscopic DCR
Microdebrider drills: 2. In frontal sinus surgeries
3. In trans sphenoid pituitary surgeries
Even though Microdebriders are not suited for 4. In Endoscopic skull base surgeries
drilling bone, the thin ethmoidal bones
can easily be drilled using drill bits in place of de- Limitations of Microdebrider:
brider blades. These drill bits are commonly used
in endoscopic dacryocystorhinostomy proce- 1. Slow rotation rates – Debrider rotate at slow
dures. These drill bits are diamond drill bits (2.5 rates (15,000 rpm) as compared to that of micro-
mm) size. The number of grooves in the drill bit drills (80,000 rpm) thus making it inefficient to
determines the speed of drilling. Fewer grooves drill bony structures.
result in faster and aggressive drilling of bone. 2. Tactile feedback is less while operating with
This always comes with a price (poor control). As Microdebriders when compared to that of con-
the number of grooves in the drill bits increas- ventional instruments
es, the bone take down rate slows down but the 3. It should be used carefully in confined spaces
control is much better. Diamond burrs cause less close to vital structures in order to avoid damage
aggressive drilling than normal burrs. to them
4. Initial cost of equipment and recurring ex-
penses incurred towards purchase of blades
increase the cost of surgery.
28
Otology
30
riorizing the surgical cavity. The posterior canal
Indications: wall is lowered up to the level of the facial nerve
canal. In order to reduce the size of the cavity,
1. Performed as a part of closed mastoidoepi- the mastoid tip is removed and a myosubcutane-
tympanectomy (combined approach) in order to ous occipital flap is created to reduce the size of
remove cholesteatoma from the hypotympanum the cavity. Meatoplasty is routinely performed.
Age is not a limitation for open mastoid proce-
2. To remove pus from the region of the round dures it can be performed with good effect even
window in acute bacterial / viral otitis media in children.
with sensorineural hearing loss
32
slope upwards with air cells lying medial to it or the area and also serves to reduce immediate
whether it is low lying. Tegmen should also be post op pain.
looked out for dehiscence. A bony defect in the
tegmen tympani or anterior wall of the epitym- Incision: Post aural incision of William Wilde
panum should raise the suspicion of an encepha- is used. A curved incision is made about 1.5 cm
locele / cholesteatoma extending into the middle behind the post auricular sulcus with a 15 blade
cranial fossa. If dehiscence is present, then MRI knife. The incision begins from just above the
should be performed to glean more details. linea temporalis and extends up to the mastoid
tip. Care must be taken not to place the incision
9. Facial nerve. The tympanic segment may be over the post auricular sulus as it would enter
dehiscent, this is common in children. In the into the external auditory canal.
presence of cholesteatoma, the tympanic seg-
ment of facial nerve can be exposed due to bone Elevation of periosteal flap: Anteriorly based
erosion. In the case of revision surgery a prior periosteal flap is developed about 1.5 cm in
knowledge of exposed facial nerve will prevent length. Periosteal elevator is used to elevate
its inadvertent damage during elevation of tym- the flap from the bone until the spine of Hen-
panomeatal flap. le’s spine is visualized and the entrance of the
external auditory canal comes into view. A
10. Presence of fistula over lateral canal can be roller gauze is inserted through the flap and the
visualized flap is pushed anteriorly and held away from
the surgical field exposing the external audito-
11. Extent of the disease can be assessed. ry canal. Self-retaining retractors are used to
retract the flap. Retractor exposes the field to
12. Status of the ossicular chain can be studied the surgeon allowing the surgeon to have both
the hands free. Retraction also reduces bleeding
Mastoidectomy can be performed under both from the area. If there are any bony overhangs a
Local anesthesia and General anesthesia. Canalplasty needs to be performed. It is always
ideal to perform this procedure always as it de-
fines the anterior limit of the surgery. The entire
Positioning: The patient is positioned supine annulus should be visible.
with head rotated away from the surgeon. Over
extension of neck should be avoided specifically Tympanomeatal flap:
in children as it could cause atlantoaxial sublux- The posterior meatal skin flap is elevated to-
ation. wards the annulus. Cotton ball soaked in adren-
aline is used to push the flap in order to reduce
Infiltration: Post auricular skin incision area is bleeding. Suction is avoided over the flap. The
infiltrated with 2% xylocaine with 1 in 200,000 annulus should be elevated from the sulcus
adrenaline. Infiltration serves to elevate the skin exposing the middle ear mucosa. The middle ear
and periosteum in that area. It also serves to mucosa is incised with an angled picked thereby
reduce bleeding during surgery. It anesthetizes entering into the middle ear cavity. The entire
34
irrigation should be done. Drilling should be while drilling in this area. The tympanic and
performed along the lateral aspect of the nerve. labyrinthine segments including geniculum lie
Drilling should not be done behind and medial in this area. The tympanic segment lies in the
to the fallopian canal. Once the facial nerve is floor of the anterior epitympanic recess. Nerve is
identified the retrofacial cells can be exenterat- supposed to lie above the cochleariform process
ed. Posterior tympanotomy: The facial nerve is which is a reliable landmark. The cog which is
skeletonized leaving a thin shelf of bone overly- a bony process in the anterior epitympanum
ing the nerve. It is followed proximally towards which extends from the tegmen tympani points
its pyramidal segment, just inferior to the lateral to the location of the facial nerve.
canal. The facial recess is approached by drilling
away the bone situated between the pyramidal
segment of the nerve posteriorly, the chorda Modified radical Mastoidectomy:
tympani and the fossa incudis superiorly. In the
absence of disease, the facial recess and stapes This procedure is performed in patients with
suprastructure is visible through the tympa- extensive cholesteatoma and in whom follow up
notomy. For removal of cholesteatoma in facial is suspected not to be regular. Hence given the
recess one has to work from both sides of the only chance to tackle the disease the surgeon
intact posterior canal wall. Epitympanotomy: should perform complete removal of the disease
If cholesteatoma does not extend significantly in the first chance itself. The procedure is the
into the attic then atticotomy is performed. This same for atticotomy. The difference being the
involves exposure of the head of the malleus and posterior canal wall is lowered up to the level of
the incus to remove soft tissue from attic. The the facial canal. The aditus, antrum and the en-
outer attic wall is removed, by drilling using a tire middle ear cavity is exteriorized as a single
diamond burr. While drilling in this area care large cavity. A meatoplasty should be performed
should be taken to ensure that the burr does not in these patients. The meatoplasty creates a large
touch the ossicles. The tegmen plate should not opening in the external ear that would commu-
be breached. nicate with the operated cavity.
36
Image showing atticotomy with preservation of Image showing Atticotomy with total removal
outer attic wall / bony bridge of bony bridge
Atticotomy can be performed in several ways, 2. Total removal of the bony bridge together
leading on to various modifications: with the lateral attic wall up to the level of teg-
men tympani, exposing the lateral attic, the ossi-
cles and the ligaments as shown in fig 2. In cases
of resorption of the ossicles or removal of the
1. Preservation of the bony bridge, by drilling remnants of the ossicles, the atticotomy can be
superior to the bony annulus and widening it further extended and the medial attic exposed.
towards the tegmen tympani. This is shown in 3. In cases of resorption of the ossicles or remov-
the illustration above. al of the remnants of the ossicles, the atticotomy
can be further extended and the medial attic
exposed.
38
superolaterally than the original bridge. This
6. In attic cholesteatoma there is often resorp- type of displacement of the bridge occurs after
tion of the bone in the region of Sharpnells’s performing an anterior attico-tympanotomy in
membrane (the scutum), and the bridge cannot order to remove the tensor tympani fold and the
remain intact in its middle or anterior part. bony plate in the anterior attic to improve the
ventilation through it.
7. In sinus cholesteatoma, starting with a pos-
terosuperior retraction of pars tensa, the poste-
rior part of the bridge can be resorbed, or may
have been removed to gain better access to this
region.
40
Image showing Bondy’s operation
If there is no need for hearing improvement Image showing attico antrostomy, or conserva-
and ossiculoplasty, the tympanic cavity is not tive radical operation, with marsupialization
opened in Bondy’s operation, whereas in conser- of an attic cholesteatoma extending into the
vative attico antrostomy a tympanoplasty is also tympanic cavity, which is open. The sac is in-
performed, either to prevent in growth of the cised, and the cholesteatoma is sucked out. The
cholesteatoma into the tympanic cavity or as a tympanic cavity is entered, with the tympano-
part of ossiculoplasty. meatal flap being elevated posteriorly.
42
In cases with a small attic cholesteatoma, good
hearing, and no significant discharge, and in
which the bottom of the cholesteatoma cannot
be seen, an atticotomy can be performed by
removing the scutum until the bottom is visi-
ble. The lateral wall of the cholesteatoma sac is
removed, and the medial wall is left in place,
improving access to the cholesteatoma sac and
facilitating migration of the keratin from the sac.
In an attic cholesteatoma involving the aditus ad
antrum, a large part of the postero superior bony
canal must be drilled in order to perform a large
atticotomy and marsupialize the cholesteatoma.
Ventilation of the antrum still occurs through
the tympanic isthmus under the body of incus
and the head of the malleus and under the medi-
al part of the cholesteatoma matrix, which is not
yet adherent to the lateral semicircular canal.
The adherence of cholesteatoma membrane to Image showing side view of a large atticotomy
the lateral semicircular canal is probably the or a small Bondy’s operation in an attic choles-
most reliable sign differentiating the atticoto- teatoma involving the aditus ad antrum, ad-
my from the Bondy’s operation in cases of attic herent to the lateral canal closing the isthmus,
cholesteatoma. In cases with adherence of the blocking the ventilation of the antrum. Even
cholesteatoma membrane to the lateral canal the after removal of the large part of the superior
aditus ad antrum is involved in the cholesteato- bony canal wall (hatched area) and the lateral
ma, and ventilation of the antrum cannot take membrane of the cholesteatoma sac (dashed
place through the tympanic isthmus. Extensive line) with good exposure of the medial choles-
removal of bone is necessary to visualize the teatoma wall, progression of the cholesteatoma
cholesteatoma sac, and the result resembles a is possible towards the antrum indicated by the
small open attico antrostomy cavity – a Bondy’s arrow.
operation.
44
Image showing simple cortical Mastoidectomy in a retro auricular approach. The antrum and
the mastoid cells are opened. The bony meatal wall is intact but thick, because the small cells
of the ear canal have not been removed. The lateral canal, the malleus, and the incus are just
visible. The outer attic wall is not opened.
Transcortical route:
46
Transmeatal route:
Approaches and mastoidectomies:
The transmeatal (trans canal) route for drilling
starts in the bone of the ear canal, either later- In Mastoidectomy, both the Endaural and the
ally or medially. This route is also described as retro auricular approaches have various advan-
the inside out route, because the initial drilling tages and disadvantages.
is from within the ear canal, e.g., with an atti- 1. The view into the attic in the retro auricu-
cotomy followed by antrostomy and retrograde lar approach is oblique, in the posteroanterior
Mastoidectomy. Through this Endaural route, an direction. In the Endaural approach, the view
atticotomy alone without Mastoidectomy can be is direct, lateromedially, and the distance to the
performed. The Mastoidectomy can start in the attic is shorter than in the retro auricular ap-
ear canal, as in the transcortical route. proach.
2. The view into the Eustachian tube orifice is
good in both approaches, but somewhat better
in the retro auricular approach.
3. The view into the posterior tympanum and
sinus tympani is better in the Endaural than in
the retro auricular approach.
4. Mastoidectomy can easily be extended in the
retro auricular approach, whereas extension
is difficult or even impossible in the Endaural
approach.
5. Cavity obliteration with muscle flaps, espe-
cially using the anterior based Palva flap and the
inferiorly pedicled Guilford flap are only possi-
ble in the retro auricular approach
48
The subclassifications of canal wall up tech- several so called intact canal wall methods, the
niques are simple Mastoidectomy, cortical bony ear canal is not intact at all, partly because
Mastoidectomy, classic intact canal wall Mas- of the extensive drilling of the medial ear canal
toidectomy, CAT. The other features of the wall, and partly because of the spontaneous
classification are the obliteration of the cavity or resorption of the lateral attic wall.
reconstruction of the ear canal or both.
Modifications of intact canal wall Mastoidec-
Open technique: tomy:
In canal wall down Mastoidectomy, the cavity 1. Atticotomy with preservation of the intact
may remain open, neither obliterated nor with bony bridge
the ear canal reconstructed. The exposed bone is 2. Atticotomy with preservation of a partly re-
simply covered with fascia or skin or not cov- sorbed bony bridge
ered at all. This type of cavity is lined by granula- 3. Atticotomy with removal of the bridge
tions and later re epithelialized. 4. Widening of the ear canal Atticotomy open-
ings of various sizes with preservation of the
Closed technique: intact non resorbed bony bridge: The goal of
this atticotomy is to obtain a good view into the
The canal wall down Mastoidectomy cavity anterior attic. The bridge remains in its normal
can be partly or totally obliterated, and the ear position.
canal partly or totally reconstructed. A partly or
totally reconstructed canal wall down cavity is Atticotomy openings of various sizes with
defined as the closed technique. preservation of a partly resorbed bony bridge:
The canal wall down mastoidectomies include Image showing Canal wall down Mastoidec-
attico antrostomy, Bondy’s operation and con- tomy with preservation of the bridge in a case
servative and classic radical mastoidectomies with spontaneous erosion of the lateral attic
with total removal of bony bridge. Modifications wall, resulting in the bridge being displaced
of canal wall down Mastoidectomy: Modifica- laterally and posteriorly.
tions are related to the preservation or partial
preservation of the bony bridge, resulting in in-
tact bridge techniques. In cases with resorption
of the lateral attic wall, the bridge can be pre-
served, but is displaced laterally and posteriorly.
The bridge may be partly resorbed, or surgi-
cally removed either posteriorly or anteriorly.
In combination with various degrees of Ossic-
ular deficiency (e.g., missing incus but present
malleus, or missing incus and malleus head)
and various types of partial bridge removal have
been described.
50
Image showing Canal wall down Mastoidec-
tomy with preservation of the bridge, which is Image of the ear canal with atticotomy and
displaced laterally and posteriorly in relation to Mastoidectomy, without bridge preservation.
the incus and malleus.
Cortical Mastoidectomy
Introduction:
Contraindications:
1. If the patient is medically unfit to undergo the Image showing post aural incision of William
surgery Wilde
2. Patients with poorly pneumatized mastoid
may make the procedure a little complex as the Sir William Wilde who popularized this inci-
vital landmarks are difficult to identify. sion as a treatment of mastoiditis is the father of
Oscar wilde. He was the first to teach otology
Anesthesia: in the United Kingdom. This incision is used
for exposing the mastoid process. It follows the
Ideally mastoidectomy is performed under post aural fold. It begins just above the upper
general anesthesia. Endotracheal tube is used to attachment of auricle, and it extends downwards
maintain the airway and to administer anesthet- to the tip of the mastoid.
ic gases and oxygen. The mastoid process in infants is not fully devel-
oped, the usual incision could injure the facial
52
nerve. In this age group the incision should be
placed more horizontally.
Infiltration:
54
found centered over the cribriform area of the
mastoid cortex which is just located posterior
and superior to the osseous external meatus.
56
3. Micro ear instruments
Modified radical mastoidectomy
Anesthesia:
This is the operative technique used to manage
cholesteatoma. In this procedure all diseased This surgery can be performed either under
tympanomastoid air cells are removed, exenter- local / General anesthesia
ated and exteriorized to the external auditory
canal. The middle ear transformer mechanism Anatomical landmarks:
is reconstructed.
1. Temporal line
Indications:
2. Henle spine
1. Cholesteatoma
3. Mastoid tip
2. CSOM with extensive middle ear granulation
4. External auditory canal
Steps of modified radical mastoidectomy:
MacEven’s triangle:
1. Drilling the mastoid cortex
This triangle contains the spine of Henle. It also
2. Exenterating mastoid air cells serves as an important landmark for mastoid an-
trum as it lies 1.2 - 1.5 mm deep to this triangle.
3. Identification of aditus
Boundaries:
4. Widening the aditus
Superior - Temporal line
5. Removal of outer attic wall (bridge)
Anterior - Postero-superior margin of bony por-
6. Lowering the facial ridge up to the level of the tion of external auditory canal
lateral canal
Posterior - Is formed by a tangential line draw to
7. Performing a meatoplasty mid point of posterior wall of external canal
Equipment needed:
58
It can be seen as whitish part of bone. Lateral performed.
canal is the critical landmark in mastoid surgery.
The second genu of the facial nerve lies inferior
to the midpoint of the lateral canal. Mastoid
portion of facial nerve can be skeletonized once
the lateral canal has been identified. The facial
nerve typically courses in a more lateral and an-
terior portion in its course from the second genu
to the stylomastoid foramen. The zygomatic
root cells lying superior to the osseous external
canal, adjacent to the glenoid fossa are opened
in patients with extensive cholesteatoma in the
epitympanum / supratubal recess.
Reverse cutting can be used to reduce the 9. For fine drilling the head of the patient
cutting power and also to avoid uncontrolled should always be supported.
movements that could make the burr to hit at
vital structures. 10. The direction of rotation of burr should
always be away when drilling over important
60
structures. (Reverse). nous (1/3) and medial bony (2/3) portions.
The medial bony portion of the external canal
11. Liberal irrigation should be performed consists of the tympanic bone which is a ringed
during the whole of the drilling process. This is lateral projection of temporal bone. There is a
more important when drilling is performed over notch in the superior portion of the tympanic
facial nerve area / labyrinth. bone known as the notch of Rivinus which is lo-
cated at the junction of tympanosquamous and
12. It will be prudent to place the suction tip tympanomastoid suture lines.
between the burr bit and an important structure
as it will prevent damage to the structure even if Sensory innervation of external auditory
the hand piece slips. canal:
13. Canalplasty should be performed whenever a 1. Auriculotemporal nerve (from the mandib-
bony overhang obscures complete visualization ular branch of the trigeminal nerve) provides
of the ear drum. sensory innervation to anterior, posterior walls
and the roof of external canal.
14. while drilling care should be taken not to 2. The posterior wall and floor of the canal is
touch the ossicular chain. supplied by the auricular branch of vagus (Ar-
nold nerve)
15. Middle cranial fossa dural plate should not 3. The tympanic plexus also supplies some areas
be drilled as this could cause CSF Otorrhoea. Blood supply:
1. Posterior auricular artery
Canalplasty 2. Deep auricular branch of the maxillary artery
3. Superficial temporal artery
Introduction:
Important anatomic relations that should be
A Canalplasty is usually performed to widen a borne in mind during surgery:
narrowed external auditory canal either due to Anterior to the bony portion of external audito-
congenital / acquired causes. The reasons for ry canal lie the temporomandibular joint and the
performing this procedure are as follows: parotid gland. During Canalplasty care should
1. To improve access to middle ear and mastoid be taken not to injure these structures. Posterior
cavities during mastoid surgeries and inferior to the bony external canal lies the
2. To remove bony / soft tissue growths / scar mastoid portion of the temporal bone and it
tissue occluding the external canal contains the facial nerve.
3. To treat aural atresia
Facial nerve courses usually lateral to the annu-
Anatomy: lus in the posteroinferior quadrant of the tym-
panic membrane.
The adult external auditory canal is about 2.5
cms long and is composed of lateral cartilagi- Function of external canal:
62
taken to avoid penetration into the TM joint.
This can be prevented by drilling away bone
superior and inferior to the temporomandibular
joint first, before carefully removing the buttress
of bone overlying the joint. After canaplasty
the skin flap is repositioned, and the wound is
closed in layers. Ideally a stent may be placed to
assist adherence of the external canal skin to the
external canal.
Introduction:
64
Image showing otoendoscopic view of attic
perforation Image showing otoendoscopic view of otomyco-
sis
66
tone average)
4. Results of this procedure was compared to
that of published results of microscopic myrin-
goplasty Puretone audiometry was performed
for all these patients. All of them had 30 – 40 dB
conductive hearing loss
Success rate of endoscopic procedure was com-
pared with that of various studies performed
using microscopic approach. Internet survey
revealed a success rate of 71% - 80% success
rates in patients undergoing microscopic my-
ringoplasty. This highly variable success rate was
attributed to the different locations of perfo-
rations. Posterior perforations carried the best
success rates i.e. 90%.
68
Image showing tympanomeatal flap being
Image showing the rim of the perforation being elevated. The incision is indicated by red line.
freshened with an angled pick Drum knife is seen in action.
70
Image showing handle of the malleus being Image showing temporalis fascia being harvest-
skeletonized. ed
Overlay technique
Overlay technique:
Myringoplasty is a procedure used to seal a This is a simpler and commonly used technique.
perforated tympanic membrane using a graft Here the graft is placed under the tympano
material. meatal flap which has been elevated hence the
name under lay. The major advantage of this
Temporalis fascia is the commonly used graft procedure is that it is easy to perform with a
material because: good success rate.
72
Prerequisites for myringoplasty
Step II:
1. Central perforation which has been dry for at
least 6 weeks This step is otherwise known as elevation of
tympano meatal flap. Using a drum knife a
2. Normal middle ear mucosa curvilinear incision is made about 3 mm later-
al to the annulus. This incision ideally extends
3. Intact ossicular chain between the 12 - o clock, 3 - o clock, and 6 - o
clock positions in the left ear, and 12 - o clock,
4. Good cochlear reserve 9 - o clock and 6 - o clock positions in the right
ear. The skin is slowly elevated away from the
Procedure: bone of the external canal. Pressure should be
applied to the bone while elevation. This serves
Firstly a temporalis fascia of adequate site must two purposes:
be harvested and allowed to dry. The surgery is
performed under local anesthesia. Temporalis 1. It prevents excessive bleeding
fascia graft is harvested under local anesthesia
conventionally and allowed to dry. The external 2. It prevents tearing of the flap
auditory canal is then anesthetised using 2 %
xylocaine mixed with 1 in 10,000 adrenaline in- This step ends when the skin flap is raised up to
jection. About 1/2 cc is infiltrated at 3 - o clock, the level of the annulus.
6 - o clock, 9 - o clock, and 12 - o clock positions
about 3mm from the annulus. The patient is Step III:
premedicated with intramuscular injections of 1
ampule fortwin and 1 ampule phenergan. Elevation of the annulus and incising the middle
ear mucosa. In this step the annulus is gradu-
Step I: ally lifted from its rim. As soon as the annulus
is elevated a sickle knife is used to incise the
Freshening the margins of perforation - In this middle ear mucosal attachment with the tym-
step the margins of the perforation is freshened pano meatal flap. This is a very important step
using a sickle knife of an angled pick. This step is because the inner layer of the remnant ear drum
very important because it breaks the adhesions is continuous with the middle ear mucosa. As
formed between the squamous margin of the ear soon as the middle ear mucosa is raised, the flap
drum (outer layer) with that of the middle ear is pushed anteriorly till the handle of the malle-
mucosa. These adhesions if left undisturbed will us becomes visible.
hinder the take up of the neo tympanic graft.
This procedure will in fact widen the already Step IV:
present perforation. There is nothing to be
alarmed about it. Freeing the tympano meatal flap from the han-
74
Indications of Myringoplasty:
Step IV: Freeing the tympano meatal flap from Since the ossicular chain lever ratio is not nor-
the handle of malleus. In this step the tympano mally maintained in these patients, they
meatal flap is freed from the handle of malleus tend to have at least 30 dB hearing loss even
by sharp dissection of the middle ear mucosa. after a successful surgery.
Sometimes the handle of the malleus may be
turned inwards hitching against the promontory.
76
grafted ear drum virtually drapes the promon-
tory.
78
Stapes to malleus reconstruction:
Selection of prosthesis:
When malleus is present, it can be used to help
Factors to be considered while selecting an opti- to stabilize thee prosthesis and reduce the possi-
mal prosthetic design are: bility of extrusion. The malleus is never directly
1. Status of ear drum aligned to the underlying stapes (M-S offset). A
2. Status of residual ossicles variety of implants have been designed to take
3. Severity of Eustachian tube dysfunction advantage of the stabilizing effect of malleus.
4. Stability of prosthesis
5. Ease of placement Incus interposition: Guilford transposed the
6. Sound conductivity residual incus autograft on to its side so that it
lies on the stapes capitulum and beneath the
manubrium. Hearing results could be excellent
80
Image showing Weher’s prosthesis
Image showing stapes replacement prosthesis
There are two types of Weher’s prosthesis: Kartush Hydroxyapatite struts: These struts were
designed to function as either a TORP or PORP.
1. Incus replacement prosthesis Hydroxyapatite was used. This prosthesis has a
2. Incus – Stapes replacement prosthesis self locking mechanism. It has very low displace-
ment and extrusion rates.
82
Image showing the prosthesis laid on its side on
the promontory
Complications:
According to MER:
0 – Best prognosis
2 – Mild risk
84
5 – Moderate risk tion in the absence of stapes suprastructure is
7 – Severe risk technically more demanding. Cartilaginous
12 – Worst prognosis homografts are effective if the patient has a wide
oval window niche. Measurements are taken as
described for PORP configuration.
86
Spandrel: This is a type of TORP. It has a wide
head which can be slid under the ear drum and
a narrow shaft. The length of the shaft can be re-
duced by cutting it. The shaft rests over the foot
plate of stapes.
88
Image showing the site of incision in the ear Image showing glue flowing out after the inci-
drum sion
Image showing grommet being pushed into the During 17th and 18th centuries, many famous
perforation surgeons attempted to explain the relationship
between the ear drum and hearing. William
Cheselden completed animal studies by per-
forming myringotomy. He wanted to conduct
human trials which was prevented. In 1748,
Julius Busson became the first person to rec-
ommend perforating the ear drum if pus was
present medial to it. Peter Degraers performed
myringotomy in Edinburgh. Sir Astley Paston
Cooper, a surgeon to Guy’s hospital can be con-
sidered the first to outline clear indications for
myringotomy.
Otitis media with effusion is an age old problem In 1804 Christian Michalis a professor of anat-
affecting young children and infants. The term omy from marburg performed tympanic mem-
“glue ear” was first coined in the year 1960. This brane perforations in 63 patients. Cooper’s strict
condition was first described by Hippocrates indication of having good bone conduction
and Aristotle. In 400 BC, Hippocrates described before performing myringotomy was ignored by
how the middle ear become filled with mucous. subsequent surgeons at their own peril.
90
tempt to liquefy the middle ear fluid facilitating
removal. Adam Politzer was actually credited
with the first use of suction to remove fluid. It
was noted by him that one of the drawbacks of
myringotomy was that the site of incision healed
spontaneously and very quickly.
92
applied to the perforation edges. obstructing the vision then it must also be re-
moved.
Applied anatomy
An incision is given along the the anteroinferior
The tympanic membrane is an oval, thin, quadrant of the ear drum along the direction of
semi-transparent membrane separating the the radial fibers of the ear drum. The incision
external and middle ear cavity. The tympanic should be approximately 3-5 mm in length.
membrane is divided into 2 parts: Grommet is inserted into the opening and the
Pars flaccida and pars tensa. The manubrium radial fibers hold the grommet in position keep-
of the malleus is attached to the medial tym- ing the perforation open.
panic membrane; where the manubrium draws
the tympanic membrane medially, a concavity
is formed. The apex of the concavity is called
the umbo. The area of tympanic membrane
superior to umbo is termed as pars flaccida; the
remainder of the ear drum is known as the pars
tensa.
Procedure
Equipment needed:
Pneumatic otoscope
Speculum
Myringotomy knife
Grommets
1. Poor general condition of the patient. The chorda tympani nerve will come into view
immediately on entering the middle ear cavity.
2. Only hearing ear.
In most patients the posterior superior bony
3. Poor cochlear reserve as shown by poor overhang must be curetted using a curette (de-
speech discrimination scores signed by House). The long process comes into
view. Curetting is continued till the base of the
94
pyramidal process is visualised. Oval window 8. Perilymph fistula
is visualised. At this point round window reflex
is tested by moving the handle of malleus and 9. Labyrinthitis
looking for movement of round window mem-
brane. In otosclerosis this reflex is absent.
Complications of stapedectomy:
1. Facial palsy
3. Vomiting
7. Dead labyrinth
Image showing chorda tympani nerve pushed Image showing stapedial tendon being cut
anteriorly
96
Image showing suprastructure of stapes being
sectioned Image showing piston being introduced
98
retraction. Everting the closure and placing a key
suture will reduce the incidence of this complica-
tion.
100
Canalplasty 2. The posterior wall and floor of the canal is
supplied by the auricular branch of vagus (Arnold
nerve)
Introduction:
3. The tympanic plexus also supplies some areas
A canalplasty is usually performed to widen a
Blood supply:
narrowed external auditory canal either due to
congenital / acquired causes. The reasons for per-
1. Posterior auricular artery
forming this procedure are as follows:
2. Deep auricular branch of the maxillary artery
1. To improve access to middle ear and mastoid
cavities during mastoid surgeries
3. Superficial temporal artery
2. To remove bony / soft tissue growths / scar
tissue occluding the external canal
Important anatomic relations that should be
3. To treat aural atresia
borne in mind during surgery:
102
and inferior to the temporomandibular joint first,
before carefully removing the buttress of bone
overlying the joint. After canaplasty the skin flap
is repositioned and the wound is closed in layers.
Ideally a stent may be placed to assist adherence
of the external canal skin to the external canal.
104
lateral cervical fistulae, preauricular sinus, and
nasolacrimal duct stenosis and fistula.
2. Branchio oto urethral syndrome – These pa-
tients have sensorineural hearing loss, preauric-
ular sinus, renal anomalies like bifid ureters and
bifid renal pelvis.
3. Branchio otic syndrome – This is a variant of
BOR syndrome. These patients
have branchial anomalies, preauricular sinus,
branchial fistula (unilateral) with no renal dyspla-
sia
4. Branchio oto costal syndrome – These patients
have conductive deafness, preauricular sinus,
bilateral commissural lip, unilateral branchial
fistula and rib anomalies
5. Cat eye syndrome – Coloboma of iris, Preau-
ricular sinus, imperforate anus and down slanting
of palpebral fissures
6. Trisomy 22 – These patients have bilateral pre-
Image showing development of Pinna auricular sinus, anti mongoloid palpebral fissures,
macroglossia, cleft palate, enlarged sub lingual
Mode of inheritance: glands and short lower limbs
106
this technique of drainage the overlying skin is
anesthetized using 2% xylocaine infiltration. The
blunt end of the lacrimal probe is inserted into
the sinus through the pit. This allows drainage to
occur via the normal opening which is usually
present in front of the ascending limb of the helix.
If preauricular abscess does not drain when this
technique is used then conventional incision and
drainage should be performed. Recurrent infec-
tions involving the preauricular sinus should be
managed by complete surgical resection of the
sinus tract completely during the stage of quies-
cence.
Image showing lacrimal probe which is used to Surgical excision of preauricular sinus:
drain preauricular abscess
While surgically excising the sinus tract care
should be taken to completely remove it. Incom-
plete removal of sinus tract is the commonest
cause for recurrence. The recurrence rate ranges
between 1 – 45% depending on the procedure
followed.
Jensma technique:
This technique was popularised by Jensma in
1970. It is actually a modification of the classic Image showing the incision marked around the
sinusotomy procedure. This technique is also preauricular sinus opening.
known as inside out technique.
Procedure:
A small skin incision around the sinus is made.
108
The main advantage of this procedure is that
the sinus can be viewed and followed from both
inside and outside. The classic procedure allows
visualization of the sinus from only outside. All
the tracts are opened and followed until the dead
end is reached. A lacrimal duct probe can be used
to establish the direction of small tracts.
It should be borne in mind that one of the tracts
could be closely adherent to the perichondrium
of the root of the helix / tragus. This piece of
perichondrium along with a small bit of under-
lying cartilage should be resected along with the
specimen.
Causes of recurrence:
110
Labyrinthectomy Trans canal labyrinthectomy:
Anesthesia:
112
cin / streptomycin. Ear lobe fat can also be used
to fill the cavity in lieu of gelfoam. Transmastoid approach:
CSF leaks if any should be repaired with tissue In this approach a post aural incision is used to
seal. The tympanomeatal flap can be replaced expose the mastoid bone. Cortical mastoidectomy
against the posterior canal wall and the ear canal is performed with a largest possible cutting burr.
is packed with gelatin foam. The aditus is identified and widened. The short
process of incus comes into view.
114
Failure to locate the utricle is a possible compli-
cation. While aspirating the peri lymphatic fluid
from the vestibule, the utricle usually retracts
superiorly to lie medial to the horizontal segment
of the facial nerve. This situation can be managed
by the use of utricular hook.
Advantages of a wide meatoplasty include: This uses the endaural approach. An inferiorly
based posterior canal skin flap is created. A radial
1. Provides adequate ventilation to the mastoid incision is given at 12 o clock position cutting the
cavity and middle ear there by preventing bacte- posterior canal wall skin. A medial circumfer-
rial ential incision is given 2-3mm lateral to the ear
growth. It also reduces conditions favorable for drum. Lateral circumferential incision is provided
growth of pathogenic bacteria. through conchal skin. A strip of conchal cartilage
2. Debris accumulation can be easily identified is cut. Temporalis fascia flap should cover the
during regular followup and cleaned. entire facial ridge and inferior part of the cavity.
3. It helps the surgeon in identification of resid-
ual / recurrent pathology in the middle ear and Surdille flap:
mastoid
cavity This flap uses endaural approach. Circumferential
4. It supports rapid epithelialization and exterior- incision is given laterally in the external canal
ization of the mastoid bowl. skin leaving a larger TM flap and a smaller lateral
flap known as the Surdille’s flap. The Surdille flap
One major draw back of a very large meatoplasty is pushed posteriorly into cavity and held in place
is that it could cause misshape the ear making it by a BIPP pack. Superiorly, anterosuperior flap
look rather unnatural. Therefore, a balance should covers the attic and tegmen and inferiorly tympa-
be struck to create a wide enough meatoplasty to nomeatal flap covers the aditus and antrum.
fulfill the ventilation requirements and it should
not cause any distortion to the shape of the pinna.
116
Image showing Surdille flap
Image showing Lempert incision
Farrior meatoplasty:
Korner Meatoplasty:
This meatoplasty is performed via endaural ap-
This meatoplasty can be performed either by proach. In this type of meatoplasty a conchal ear
endaural or post aural approach. If endaural canal skin flap is created.
approach is preferred then Lempert / Heerman II
incision is preferred. In Heerman’s incision two Fleury meatoplasty:
radial incisions are given in the external auditory
canal at 6&12 o clock positions. A circumferential This type of meatoplasty is performed endaurally.
incision is used to joint these two incisions close It is a superior based vascular flap with a lateral
to the ear drum. circumferential incision starting at the 2 o clock
position.
These incisions divide the flap into medial tym-
panomeatal flap and a lateral korner’s flap. The
Korner’s flap is pushed posteriorly into the sur-
gical cavity and is held in position with a BIPP
pack.
Image showing Farrior meatoplasty incisions: Fleury incision has two components. One
circumferential incision to elevate tympanome-
1. Anterior circumferential incision at 4 o clock atal flap medially and a vertical incision at 10 o
positions clock position as shown above.
2. Posterior circumferential incisions
3. Vertical incisions
4. Anterior vertical incisions Large lateral flap of Surdile is created. This flap is
5. Posterior vertical incisions made to cover the facial ridge & lower part of the
6. Lateral incision – This allows further eleva- mastoid cavity. The vertical incision (skin) is su-
tion of skin tured first. It pulls the upper part of pinna further
upwards.
118
1. Three flaps are created i.e. lateral, superior, and
inferior Portmann’s large 5 flap meatoplasty with removal
2. There is no removal of conchal cartilage of cartilage:
3. Very useful for small cavities
4. Lateral circumferential incision from 12 to 6 The ear canal skin is divided at 9 o clock position.
o clock position is made 10 mm lateral to upper
tympanic membrane Laterally at the conchal cartilage the following
5. Upper lateral incision from the upper part of incisions are given:
circumferential incision to the spine of Henle
6. Similar lower incision from inferior edge of 1. One incision that turns infero anteriorly
circumferential incision towards the concha 2. One incision that turns supero anteriorly
This results in lateral, superior and inferior flap.
120
cartilage. and periosteum are elevated and constitute a large
palva flap.
The two liberated flaps are inverted posteriorly Another incision is made along the entrance of
around the edge of the concha and sutured to the canal from 6 to 12 o clock through subcutane-
posterior aspect of concha creating a meatoplasty. ous tissue and periosteum.
Palva flap:
122
Incision:
Linea temporalis
A C shaped incision is made with a 15-blade
scalpel 3-4 cm posterior to the post aural crease Mastoid emissary foramen
extending up to the mastoid tip.
Asterion
Henle’s spine
• Asterion
Skin and subcutaneous tissue flap is elevated an- Fukushima Inner triangle (Trautmann’s triangle)
teriorly up to the external acoustic meatus. Next
an offset incision is created through the tempora-
lis muscle, fascia and periosteum. This helps later • Anterior – Superior (anterior) semicircular
during wound closure as the wound can be closed canal
in layers. This layered closure helps in prevention
of CSF leak. • Superior – Superior petrosal vein
124
and retrofacial air cells are covered with tempora-
lis fascia. The entire mastoid cavity is obliterated
using abdominal fat graft to prevent CSF leak.
The wound is then closed in layers.
Image showing endolymphatic sac being exposed Image showing structures seen after reflecting
posterior fossa dura
Complications:
2. Cerebellar edema
6. CSF leak
126
Arterial line should be started to monitor real
Preoperative evaluation: time blood pressure.
Patient should be catheterized in order to accu-
1. Pure-tone audiogram and speech audiogram. rately maintain fluid balance.
This helps in ascertaining whether the patient has Perioperative antibiotics need to be administered
serviceable hearing or not. (cefazoline / amoxycillin/clavulanic acid) and
2. HR CT scan. This is performed for diagnostic they should be continued for 1 week postopera-
purposes as in the case of bone dysplasias and tively.
superior canal dehiscence syndrome. Hydrocortisone administration intravenously
3. MRI scan with gadolinium if neuronitis / ede- is advisable in the event of intraoperative nerve
ma which is specific for evaluation of facial nerve. manipulation.
When gadolinium contrast is used, then normal
facial nerve enhances faintly in the geniculate Procedure:
ganglion area, tympanic and mastoid segments.
The cisternal, intracanalicular, labyrinthine and The hair over the temporal region is shaven and
parotid segments of the nerve do not normal- the surgical field is sterilized.
ly enhance. Enhancement of the nerve in these The head is fixed in a skull clamp. Patient is
regions should cause suspicion of inflammatory / positioned with 3-point body straps in order to
neoplastic process involving the nerve. Asymmet- allow easy rolling of the bed of the patient during
ric enhancement / thickening of the tympanic / surgery to improve exposure.
mastoid segments relative to the contralateral side Electrodes are placed to monitor facial nerve and
should be considered as abnormal. In Bell’s palsy, auditory brain stem response is also recorded by
MRI with gadolinium contrast demonstrates placement of electrodes in real time. To monitor
enhancement of the intracanalicular and labyrin- facial nerve electrodes are placed over orbicularis
thine segments of the facial nerve. There is also oculi and orbicularis oris. The ground electrode is
greater degree of enhancement of the geniculate placed on the chest. ABR click generator is placed
ganglion, tympanic and mastoid segments. over the operative side ear canal. The ABR elec-
4. Diffusion weighted MRI scan in patients with trodes are placed one on each mastoid and one
supralabyrinthal / congenital apex cholesteato- over the vertex.
mas.
5. Sequential brainstem-evoked auditory poten- Two incisions can be used.
tials can be used to detect subclinical auditory
nerve damage 1. Anterior/inferiorly based skin flap. This inci-
6. Vestibular function testing sion starts anterior to tragus, extending posterior-
ly to about 3-4 cms posterior to pinna, superiorly
Anesthetic considerations: 5-6 cm, and anteriorly again to the temporal hair
General anesthesia is preferred with orotracheal line. This incision is good for extended middle
intubation. Short acting non depolarizing cranial fossa approaches. The temporalis muscle
muscle relaxant should be used to facilitate nerve is reflected inferiorly.
monitoring equipment usage. 2. Posteriorly based skin flap. This incision starts
just behind the temporal hair line and a rounded
Craniotomy:
128
dura is elevated along the floor
of middle cranial fossa from posterior to anterior
so that the greater superficial nerve is protected.
During this stage the arcuate eminence, greater
superficial petrosal nerve and petrous ridge are
identified.
Elevation of Dura:
Image showing arcuate eminence The bone over the internal acoustic meatus is
drilled till it becomes paper thin. The thinned
Identification of arcuate eminence is vital as it out bone can be removed using a 90° pick. The
indicates the approximate level of the superior skeletonization of internal auditory canal should
semicircular canal which invariably lies under- be continued up to the level of Bill’s bar. The lab-
neath. Greater superficial petrosal nerve should yrinthine segment of the facial nerve is identified
also be identified before proceeding any further. at the transverse crest. The cochlea lies deeper
The internal acoustic meatus is known to bisect than the plane of the labyrinthine segment of the
the angle formed by these two landmarks. facial nerve. If the surgeon does not drill deep to
the facial nerve anteriorly then cochlea will not be
violated. Auditory brain stem potentials should
be continuously monitored by an audiologist at
this stage.
130
Dura over the internal auditory canal over the Closure of craniotomy:
superior vestibular nerve is excised exposing the
contents. A direct auditory nerve electrode is The House urban retractor is removed to allow
placed between the dura of the internal acoustic the temporal lobe to re expand. Bone flap is re-
meatus and the cochlear nerve for monitoring the placed and secured. Wound is closed in layers.
cochlear action potential in real time.
Closure:
History
132
meet with the expected success. mm wide close to the floor of the nasal cavity.
One year later Berlin Hermann Krause modified
The very first officially recognized reference text this technique by adding a drainage tube. Three
that described normal anatomy of nasal cavities years later, Ernst G.F. Kuster proposed the valid-
and paranasal sinuses was “Normal and Patholog- ity of the sublabial approach via the canine fossa
ic anatomy of nose and its accessory pneumatic creating an opening not bigger than a little finger
cavities” published by Emil Zuckerkandl in 1882. on which he placed a rubber plug, which can be
In this treatise the nose was considered insepara- removed if need to facilitate drainage of maxillary
ble from the surrounding structures. This book antrum.
was the source of inspiration for all rhinologists
of those times. Markus Hajek after a few years In 1893 George Walter Caldwell popularized
following publication of this book published a Lemorier’s technique suggesting the possibility
book titled “Pathology and therapy of inflam- of creating a “window” in the lateral wall of the
matory diseases of the nose and nasal passages”. inferior meatus via the canine fossa. This ap-
Another book authored by Grunwald explained proach was performed for the first time in Europe
how acute and chronic inflammations were the in 1896 in Breslau by Georg Boenninghaus. He
cause for sinusitis. This book was titled as “Book slightly modified this technique placing a mucous
on the nasal suppuration”. flap on the created fenestration. An identical
procedure was described by Robert H S Spicer
Origins of Paranasal sinus surgery and Henry Paul Luc in London and Paris. An-
other modification which was proposed is the
In the 1st century in Pompei, speculum shaped counter opening of the maxillary sinus through
nasal dilators were used for the visualization of the inferior meatus. Howard Lothrop published
the nasal cavities. For a long time the role of in 1897, the importance of a big fenestration in
interventional treatment remained limited com- the inferior meatus.
pared to the diagnostic options due to the pecu-
liar conformation of this anatomical area which Raymond Charles Claoue adopted intranasal
comprises of slits, recesses, reduced volumes antrostomy as a treatment for chronic maxillary
and narrow passes restricted by bony walls. The sinus infections. He also published his experi-
chance of surgical drainage of paranasal sinuses, ence in 1912. All these conservative treatments
in particular of the maxillary sinus was consid- were set aside after the introduction of innovative
ered only from the 17th-18th century. radical interventions in 1900. During this time
Gustav Killian described the resection of the un-
Towards the end of the 19th century, several cinate process with the enlargement of the nearby
authors started to perform puncture of the maxil- ostium. Halle was the first author to claim a large
lary sinus. Johann von Mikulicz-Radecki suggest- personal experience on intranasal ethmoidectomy
ed that antrum could be accessed via the middle and frontal and sphenoidal sinusotomies.
meatus. He was the first surgeon to introduce in
1886 the concept of antrostomy for the drainage In 1909, Dahmer performed an inferior antros-
of maxillary antrum. He recommended creation tomy cutting the anterior part of the inferior
of an opening measuring 20 mm long and 5-10 turbinate. This opening was so wide, that the
134
disease, particularly chronic frontal sinusitis disease. The mucosa was stripped to the level of
which could be a highly morbid / sometimes life frontal recess, and a stent was placed for tem-
threatening condition due to its potential compli- porary drainage. In 1898 Riedel described the
cations. Despite these advancements, orbital and first procedure for obliteration of frontal sinus.
intracranial complications following frontal sinus He advocated complete removal of the anterior
infections continue to occur. table as well as the floor of the frontal sinus with
stripping off the mucosa. This procedure had the
History of frontal sinus surgery can be conve- advantage of removing osteomyelitic bone as well
niently divided into three eras for better under- as allowing for easy detection of recurrent dis-
standing: ease. This procedure caused unsightly cosmetic
forehead deformity. Killian in 1903 described a
Era of Trephination (1750) modification of the Riedel-Schenke procedure.
This modification involved preservation of one
Era of radical ablation procedures (1895) centimeter bar of the supraorbital rim. He also
recommended an ethmoidectomy y with rota-
Era of conservative procedures (1905) tion of mucosal flap into the frontal sinus with
stenting to prevent stenosis. Killian’s procedure
was abandoned because of the high incidence of
Era of Trephination: late morbidity with restenosis, supraorbital rim
necrosis, postoperative meningitis and mucocele
Frontal sinus surgery was first described in the formation as well as death.
18th century. It was documented that as early as
1750, Runge performed an obliteration procedure Era of conservative procedure:
of the frontal sinus. The first report to be pub-
lished was in 1870 by Wells describing an external Because of the risk of significant cosmetic defor-
and intracranial drainage procedure for a frontal mity as well as the high failure rate of those abla-
sinus mucocele. tive external procedures, an era of conservatism
followed as a natural corollary. This era was char-
In 1884 Alexander Ogston described a trephi- acterised by intranasal approaches to frontal sinus
nation procedure through the anterior table to as well as external frontoethmoid techniques.
evaluate the frontal sinus. He also dilated the In 1908, Knapp described an ethmoidectomy
naso-frontal duct, curetted the mucosa and estab- through the medial wall and entering the frontal
lished drainage with a tube that was inserted into sinus through its floor, by which he removed dis-
the duct. This tube kept the duct patent. eased mucosa and enlarged the naso frontal duct.
This operation did not receive widespread recog-
Era of Radical Ablation Procedure: nition. In 1911, Schaeffer proposed an intranasal
puncture technique to re-establish the drainage
At the turn of the century a number of physicians and ventilation of the frontal sinus. Numerous
were advocating a radial frontal sinus procedure. complications were encountered which included
Kuhnt in 1895 described removing the anterior intracranial penetration. Between 1901 and 1908,
wall of the frontal sinus in an attempt to clear the Ingals, Halle, Good, and Wells described several
136
Prof Dr Balasubramanian Thiagarajan
Antral Puncture and Lavage
Anatomy of inferior meatus:
Introduction:
Inferior meatus is the largest of the three meatus-
Focus on maxillary sinus cavity pathology dates es of the nasal cavity. This is actually the space
back to the 17th century. Treatment for suppura- between the inferior turbinate and the lateral
tion of maxillary sinus was common during that nasal wall. It extends almost the entire length of
period. One of the earliest descriptions of intra- the lateral wall of the nose. It is broader in front
nasal antrostomy as an approach to maxillary than behind which makes it easy
sinus was dated back to 1770 by Gooch. Routine for accessing the lateral nasal wall from here. An-
puncture of maxillary sinus via the inferior me- teriorly the nasolacrimal duct opens here.
atus was performed during 1880’s following the
classic publication of Lichwitz who designed the Inferior turbinate is a separate bone unlike the
classic trocar and cannula that can be used for superior and middle turbinates which are compo-
performing the procedure. nents of ethmoid bone. Inferior concha / inferior
turbinate matures via endochondral ossification.
Krause in 1887, Mickulicz in 1887 standard-
ized the procedure. Mickulicz understood the Articulations of inferior turbinate:
anatomical and physiological pitfalls of inferior
meatal antrostomy which included its propensity Anterior – Frontal process of maxilla
for spontaneous closure making it a temporary Anteromedial – Articulates with the uncinate
procedure. This was hence gradually replaced by process of ethmoid bone and lacrimal bone
canine fossa antrostomy (Caldwell Luc proce- Posteromedial – Perpendicular plate of palatine
dure) by 1897. bone
Acute maxillary sinusitis was common problem Indications for antral lavage:
during the 17th and 18th centuries. Radiological
investigations were not commonly available hence 1. Acute bacterial maxillary sinusitis causing pres-
antral lavage was used as a sure symptoms in middle of face
diagnostic as well as a therapeutic procedure for 2. Feeling of numbness of teeth / symptoms that
diagnosing and treating acute maxillary sinusitis. does not resolve with medical management
Antral puncture and aspiration remained gold 3. Patients with maxillary sinusitis who are not
standard for diagnosing acute maxillary sinusitis fit for general anesthesia to perform functional
for a long time. endoscopic sinus surgery
With the advent of functional endoscopic sinus 4. Patients on assisted mechanical ventilation
surgery antral lavage has fallen out of fashion. But who commonly develop sinusitis (nearly 40% of
it should be stated that it remains still the most them develop). Lavage in these patients can be
cost-effective procedure in diagnosing and man- performed as a bedside procedure under local
aging maxillary sinus infections. anesthesia to clear the pent-up secretions from
the maxillary sinuses.
138
5. In patients with permanent disability of muco- sia. Topical anesthesia is produced by using 4%
ciliary clearance mechanism like kartagener’s syn- xylocaine soaked nasal pledgets. Topical anes-
drome and Young’s syndrome. In these patients thesia lasts about 45 minutes which is more than
FESS is almost useless and only inferior meatal sufficient for completion of the procedure. While
antrostomy could salvage them. using 4% xylocaine topical anesthesia it should be
ensured that the maximum volume of drug used
Contraindications: should not exceed 7ml. A reasonable dose of xy-
locaine that is safe for topical use is 4mg/kg body
1. In young children in whom maxillary sinus is weight. By mixing xylocaine with adrenaline,
not fully developed. Maxillary sinus completes its the effect of the drug can be prolonged plus the
development only after the age of 9. added benefit of vasoconstriction which reduces
2. Blow out fracture of orbit / history of blow out bleeding. Ideal is to mix I ampule of adrenaline to
fracture of orbit because irrigated fluid from the one 30 ml bottle of 4% xylocaine. This will ensure
sinus could infuse into the orbit via the fracture that adrenaline concentration is about 1 in 10000
line causing orbital problems units. Cottonoids if available are preferred to
3. Patients who have undergone previous surger- pledgets.
ies involving the lateral nasal wall as the needle
could enter through the posterior wall of maxil- Each nasal cavity should be packed with 3 packs
lary sinus into the pterygopalatine fossa soaked with 4% xylocaine with 1in 10000 units
4. In patients with atrophic rhinitis because the adrenaline. Before packing the pack should be
lateral nasal wall will be pretty thick in these squeezed to remove excess xylocaine. The first
patients making the procedure rather difficult. It pack is placed over the floor of the nasal cavity,
may require a chisel and gouge to create inferior the second one is placed in the inferior meatus.
meatal opening in these patients. Simple trocar The third pack is placed in the middle meatus
and cannula would not do. area. Surgeon should be aware that the posterior
pharyngeal wall mucosa would also be anesthe-
Procedure: tized by xylocaine trickling into that area. This
could cause the patient to aspirate because the
This procedure involves introduction of a cannu- sensation is lost. The surgeon should be conscious
la into the maxillary sinus cavity via an opening about this problem while performing the proce-
made in the inferior meatus. This procedure is dure. The patient should be instructed not to sniff
rather outdated these days because the maxillary while nasal packing is done as it would promote
sinus drainage in the presence of normal muco drug to trickle into the posterior pharyngeal wall.
ciliary clearance mechanism is not dependent on
gravity. The beating cilia always propels the se- A short description of innervation of nose and
cretions from the sinus cavity towards the natural nasal cavity would not be out of place. Nasal
ostium which is situated slightly above. There is innervation can be simplified by dividing it into
no point in expecting gravity to work against the internal (mucosal) innervation and external (in-
natural muco ciliary clearance mechanism. nervation involving the skin of the nose).
The interior of nasal cavity is subdivided into the Image showing the theory behind antral wash
nasal septum, lateral nasal walls and the cribri-
form plate. The superior inner aspect of lateral
nasal wall is supplied by the anterior and posteri-
or ethmoidal nerves. The sphenopalatine gangli-
on is located in the posterior end of the middle
140
The patient is comfortably seated in a chair with
adequate back support. Eye pad should be used
to blind the patient. This will reduce the anxiety
level of the patient.
Complications:
1. Bleeding
2. Orbital damage. Perforation of orbital floor will
cause proptosis and pain
3. Cheek swelling: This is caused by breaching the
soft tissue of the cheek and the anterior wall of
the sinus.
4. Air embolism due to injury to veins
5. Infection of maxillary sinus
6. Vaso vagal shock
142
Maxillectomy
Indications for maxillectomy:
Introduction:
1. Malignant tumors involving maxilla / lateral
The concept of maxillectomy was first described nasal wall
by Lazars in 1826. After this description it took 2. Fungal infections causing extensive destruction
nearly three years for Syme to perform the first of sinuses
maxillectomy (1829). Earlier attempts at this sur- 3. Chronic granulomatous diseases involving nose
gery failed because of excessive bleeding. Bleed- and sinuses
ing and infection were two scrooges which 4. As a part of combined excision of skull base
caused unacceptable morbidity and mortality in neoplasm
patients following maxillectomy. In 1927 Port-
mann & Retrouvey suggested sublabial transoral Partial maxillectomy procedures are indicated in
approach to remove maxilla. This approach patients with:
obviated the use of disfiguring facial incisions.
Rapid advances which took place in the field of 1. Slow growing tumors involving nose and sinus-
anesthesia and surgical techniques in 1950 rekin- es (inverted papilloma)
dled the interest in total maxillectomy as a viable 2. Tumors localized to inferior wall of maxilla
treatment option for malignant lesions involving
maxilla. It was during this period that Weber Important considerations before deciding on
Ferguson came out with his epoch making lat- surgery:
eral rhinotomy incision which caused very little
cosmetic deformity. Later various modifications 1. Extent of the lesion
of these incisions were used to perform maxillec- 2. Histopathology of the lesion
tomy. 3. Involvement of adjacent areas
4. Precise location of the bulk of the mass
In 1954 Smith did what was considered impos-
sible. He combined total maxillectomy with Role of Nasal endoscopy and clinical examina-
orbital exenteration. It was only after Smith’s tion:
demonstration of extended total maxillectomy
curative surgery for maxillary carcinomas began This is really vital in deciding not only the extent
to take center stage. Fairbanks & Barbosa (1961) of the disease but also in determining the optimal
described infratemporal fossa approach to resect treatment modality. It also helps in discussing
advanced malignancies of maxilla. These tumors prognostic issues with the patient and their near
were considered to be inoperable till then. ones.
In 1977 Sessions & Larson first envisaged medial It helps in examination of the nasal cavity and
maxillectomy and were also responsible for coin- also provides the first look at the disease process
ing the term. With the advent of nasal endoscope from which biopsy can be done. Spread of lesion
resection of tumors involving lateral nasal wall outside the confines of maxilla by eroding the
under endoscopic vision is the order of the day. antero lateral wall can be ascertained by careful
Role of prosthodontist:
144
Role of ophthalmologist: Ryles tube insertion:
Ophthalmic examination helps in ruling out oc- This is ideally performed before anesthetizing the
ular involvement. If orbit is involved then max- patient. Ryles tube in position will help in feeding
illectomy will have to be combined with orbital the patient during the initial post-operative peri-
exenteration. od. Even though it is not a must if inserted serves
a good purpose.
Procedure:
Hypotensive anesthesia can be administered if
This surgery is ideally performed under general there is no contraindication as it would help in
anesthesia. Administration of pre-operative anti- minimizing blood loss during the procedure. If
biotics has been considered to reduce incidence endotracheal intubation is preferred to tracheos-
of post op infections. Ideally it should be a broad tomy then oral intubation is ideal. The endotra-
spectrum antibiotic which could cover the nor- cheal tube should be secured to the side opposite
mal flora of nasal and oral cavities. to that of the tumor. It is anchored to the lower lip
without distorting the upper lip.
The question whether tracheostomy should be
performed or not is determined by the extent of Position:
lesion and the amount of palate that needs to be
removed. If large amount of palatal tissue needs Patient is put in supine position with head turned
to be removed to give adequate tumor margins 180° from the anesthetist.
then it is safer to resort to preliminary tracheos-
tomy. Incision:
Advantages of preliminary tracheostomy include: Even though various incisions are available au-
thor prefers to use Weber Ferguson incision and
1. Anesthesia can be administered through it its various modifications. Modifications of Weber
2. Provides unhindered view of oral cavity which Ferguson incision is necessary if other areas like
is helpful during oral phases of surgery orbit needs to be attended. Lateral canthotomy
3. It helps to secure airway during post op period can be combined with Weber Ferguson incision
even in the presence of intra oral edema. to expose orbital boundaries and malar area. Lip
splitting incision a modification of Weber Fergu-
Tarsorraphy is performed on the side of lesion. son incision is preferred if infratemporal fossa is
This helps in protecting eye and cornea from involved.
injury. Lateral tarsorraphy alone could suffice if it
could provide adequate eye closure. Ideally silk is
used to perform this procedure. Before perform-
ing tarsorraphy it would be prudent on the part
of the surgeon to apply eye ointment in order to
prevent excessive drying of cornea.
146
Image showing the infraorbital limb of the inci-
sion Image showing incision is ideally deepened up
to the subperiosteal plane by using diathermy
cautery. Use of cautery minimizes bleeding to a
great extent.
Identification of lacrimal sac and duct: This is a critical step during the procedure as
it gives excellent opportunity to the surgeon
The lacrimal sac is identified, dissected and re- to identify orbital involvement. If periorbita is
tracted. This maneuver stretches and exposes the breached by the tumor then it calls for histolog-
lacrimal duct. The nasolacrimal duct is usually ical confirmation of orbital involvement. Frozen
transected at its junction with the sac. The sac is section will of used during this stage of the proce-
marsupialized. This is performed by dividing the dure.
sac and suturing the edges to the periorbita.
Tip:
148
Tip:
150
Image showing maxillectomy specimen
Complications:
1. Intraoperative hemorrhage
2. Troublesome Epiphora
3. Damage to orbital structures
4. Damage to cornea
5. Visual disturbances
6. Loss of vision due to over packing the maxil-
lectomy cavity compromising vascularity of optic
nerve
7. Velopharyngeal incompetence (Nasal leak of
ingested fluids)
8. Cosmetic defects / scars
9. Trismus due to scarring of muscles of mastica-
tion
152
Prof Dr Balasubramanian Thiagarajan
SUBMUCOSAL RESECTION OF NA- United States. Using a special saw, the deviated
SAL SEPTUM & SEPTOPLASTY portion of the nasal septum was removed along
with its corresponding mucosa. The results of this
procedure were therefore suboptimal.
Introduction:
Ingals (1882) was the first to introduce en-bloc
Nasal obstruction is a common complaint that
resection of small sections of septal cartilage.
brings the patient to a doctor. If it is caused by
Because of this innovation he is considered to be
deviated
the father of modern septal surgeries. During this
nasal septum then correction of this deviation be-
period cocaine was being widely used as topical
comes mandatory. A successful septal correction
anesthetic for surgical procedures.
surgical procedure really improves the quality of
life of the patient. Submucosal resection of na-
Ash (1899) was the first person to suggest that al-
sal septum and septoplasty are two commonly
tering the tensile curve of septal cartilage straight-
performed surgeries with an aim to correct the
ened it without resorting to actual resection.
septal deviation and improve nasal airway. The
type of surgery depends on the type of deviation.
Freer and Killain (1902 & 1904) described the
If the deviation of nasal septum is anterior to the
submucosal resection of nasal septum. This
Cottle’s line (a vertical imaginary line dropped
procedure served as the foundation of modern
between the nasal processes of frontal and maxil-
septoplasty techniques. They advocated raising
lary bones) septoplasty is preferred. If the devia-
mucoperichondrial flaps and resecting the car-
tion is posterior to this line submucosal resection
tilaginous and bony septum (which included
of nasal septum is preferred.
the vomer and perpendicular plate of ethmoid),
leaving 1 cm dorsally and 1 cm caudally to main-
History:
tain support.
First description of nasal surgery could be found
Metzenbaum and Peer (1929) were the first to
in the Ebers Papyrus (3500 B.C) written in Egyp-
manipulate the caudal septum using a variety
tian. The procedures described in this papyrus
of techniques. The classic SMR is ineffective /
was reconstructive in nature because rhinectomy
less effective in correcting this area of deviation.
was a frequent form of punishment those days.
Metzenbaum also in addition advocated the use
of swinging door technique.
Quelmatz (1757) was one of the earliest physi-
cians to address septal deformities. His famous
In 1937 Peer recommended removal of caudal
recommendation was the application of digital
portion of nasal septum, straightening it and then
pressure on the septum on a daily basis. He be-
replacing it in the midline position.
lieved this procedure could correct the deviation
and make the septum to become straight.
Cottle in 1947 introduced the hemitransfixation
incision and the practice of conservative septal
Adams (1875) recommended fracturing and split-
resections.
ting of nasal septum. Bosworth operation: This
was rather popular in late 19th century in the
154
2. During an acute episode of rhinitis
Cottle’s types of septal deviations: 3. In the presence of bleeding diathesis
4. If the patient is having untreated DM & HT
Cottle has classified septal deviations into three
types: Anesthesia:
Simple deviations: Here there is mild deviation of
nasal septum, there is no nasal obstruction. This This surgery can be performed both under local
is the / General anesthesia. GA is used only in appre-
commonest condition encountered. It needs no hensive patients. The basic advantage of LA is that
treatment. there is minimal bleeding during the surgery and
Obstruction: There is more severe deviation of the entire surgery can be performed as a day care
the nasal septum, which may touch the lateral procedure.
wall of the nose, but on vasoconstriction the
turbinates shrink away from the septum. Hence Position:
surgery is not indicated even in these cases.
Impaction: There is marked angulation of the The patient is placed in a reclining position with
septum with a spur which lies in contact with head end of the table raised.
lateral nasal wall. The space is not increased even
on vasoconstriction. Surgery is indicated in these The nasal cavities are packed strips of roller gauze
patients. dipped in 4% xylocaine with 1 in 100,000 units
adrenaline. The gauze strips should be squeezed
Indications of SMR: to remove excess xylocaine before inserting into
the nasal cavities. This is done to minimize xy-
1. Deviated nasal septum causing symptoms of locaine absorption by the nasal cavity mucosa as
nasal obstruction and recurrent head aches this could cause systemic toxicity. On no account
2. Deviated nasal septum causing obstruction to the volume of 4% xylocaine used for topical an-
ventilation of paranasal sinuses and middle ear esthesia should exceed 7ml. One strip is placed in
causing recurrent sinusitis and ear infections the floor of the nose, the second one is placed to
3. Recurrent epistaxis from a septal spur occupy the middle portion of the nasal cavity. The
4. As a part of septorhinoplasty for cosmetic cor- third strip is placed superior to the second one.
rection of external nasal deformities Both nasal cavities should be packed. The author
5. As a preliminary step in trans-septal trans prefers to pack the nose even if the surgery is
sphenoidal hypophysectomy, vidian neurectomy performed under GA as it shrinks the turbinates
6. To obtain cartilage graft thereby creating more space for the surgeon.
7. For closure of septal perforations
Infiltration of nasal septum:
Contraindications:
It is done at the mucocutaenous junction on both
1. Patients below the age of 17 as it would impede sides with 2% xylocaine with 1 in 100,000 adren-
growth of middle third of face by interfering with aline.
growth centers. Successful infiltration not only produces anes-
156
Indications:
Complications of SMR:
1. Symptomatic deviated nasal septum
1. Bleeding 2. As part of rhinoplasty procedures
2. Septal hematoma - If the nasal cavity is prop- 3. To remove septal spur that cause epistaxis
erly packed then this will not be a problem. If he- Contraindications:
matoma is present then it should be evacuated by 1. Acute nasal or sinus infection
application of digital pressure and nasal cavities 2. Untreated DM and HT
should be repacked again. 3. Bleeding diathesis
3. Septal abscess - This usually follows septal
hematoma Anesthesia is as enumerated for SMR surgery.
4. Septal perforation - Occurs when the other side The septum is infiltrated with 2% xylocaine with
of the nasal septum is breached during elevation 1 in 100,000 adrenaline. Incision is usually giv-
of mucoperichondrial flap en on the concave side of nasal septum. Freer’s
5. Depression of Bridge of nose - This usually oc- hemitransfixation incision is preferred. This is
cur at the supratip area due to too much removal made at the lower border of the septal cartilage. A
of cartilage along the dorsal border. unilateral incision is sufficient. Three tunnels are
6. Columellar retraction - This is seen often when created as shown in the figure below.
the caudal strip of cartilage is not preserved
7. Persistence of deviation - Usually is the result Exposure:
of incomplete surgery
8. Flapping septum - This is due too much remov- The cartilaginous and bony septum are exposed
al of septal framework. The septum flaps to either by complete elevation of a mucosal flap on one
side during respiration side only. Since the flap is retained on the oppo-
9. Toxic shock syndrome - This is due to strep- site side the vascularity of the septum is retained
tococcal / staphylococcal infection. It should be and not compromised.
diagnosed early and managed by removal of nasal Mobilization and straightening:
pack, hydrating the patient and infusing parenter-
al antibiotics. The septal cartilage is freed from all its attach-
ments apart from the mucosal flap on the convex
Septoplasty: side.
Most of the deviations are maintained by extrin-
Septoplasty is a conservative approach to sep- sic factors such as caudal dislocation of cartilage
tal surgery. As much as the septal framework is from the vomerine groove. Mobilization alone
retained. will correct this problem. When deviations are
The mucoperichondrial / periosteal flap is ele- due to intrinsic causes like the presence of healed
vated only on one side. Anesthesia and patient fracture line then it must be excised along with a
position is the same as for SMR surgery. strip of cartilage. Bony deviations are treated ei-
ther by fracture and repositioning or by resection
of the fragment itself.
Fixation:
158
Advantages of Septoplasty:
160
In patients with severe mucociliary irreversible
damage (Kartagener’s syndrome, Young’s syn- The adult maxillary sinus is about:
drome) this could be the only approach to drain
infected material from maxillary sinuses. 25-35 mm wide
36-45 mm high
Procedure: 38-45 mm long
This surgery can be done under local / general Its average volume is about 15 ml /(one fluid
anesthesia. ounce).
Superior wall of maxillary sinus – orbital floor.
This sometimes can be dehiscent. The infraorbital
nerve is on the roof of the sinus. Medially and
posteriorly the roof is composed of the floor of
the ethmoid sinuses.
This foramen transmits infraorbital nerve, artery It should be pointed out that no significant blood
and vein. The infraorbital neurovascular bun- vessels are encountered during this surgical
dle traverses a groove in the orbital floor which procedure with the exception of small infraorbital
happens to be the roof of maxillary sinus. This vessels that exit from the infraorbital foramen.
area can also be dehiscent in some individuals. Significant bleeding is possible only when one
The neurovascular bundle exits via the infraorbit- breaches the posterior wall of the maxilla and
al foramen which is located approximately 5 mm enters the pterygopalatine fossa where internal
below the mid-portion of the inferior orbital rim maxillary artery can be encountered.
to enter the soft tissues of the cheek. Branches of
this nerve supply the lower eyelid, nose, cheek,
and upper lip. Care should be taken while elevat-
162
xylocaine adrenaline mixture and is placed in the
sublabial area on the side of surgery. This is done
to anesthetize the mucosa over canine fossa.
164
can be introduced via the antrostomy opening to maxillary antrum via inferior meatal antrostomy.
visualize even these hidden areas. One end of the ribbon gauze used to pack the
antrum is brought out via the inferior meatal an-
If the pterygopalatine fossa needs to be ap- trostomy making their later removal via the nasal
proached then the posterior wall of the maxillary cavity that much easier. Mucosal wound is closed
sinus antrum should be breached using gouge using 3-0 chromic catgut. The antral pack can be
and hammer or a cutting burr. removed via the nasal cavity after 48 hours as it is
accessible through the inferior meatal antrostomy.
Creation of naso antral window in the inferior
meatus:
The gouge is held in the dominant hand with Image showing antrostomy in the canine fossa
index finger serving as a guard to control the
perforation process. The gouge is slipping into the
inferior meatus. As soon as it hinges in the lateral
nasal wall the medial wall of antrum is perforat-
ed at the junction of anterior third and posterior
2/3 of inferior meatus. Its unique tip ensures that
it holds the bone fragment after perforation is
made on withdrawal. Medicated nasal pack can
be introduced via the inferior meatal antrostomy
using long-curved forceps and delivered into the
Post-operative care:
Image showing the antral mucosa via the antros- 1. Ice packs can be used over cheek to reduce
tomy oedema and discomfort
2. Nasal and antral packing can be removed be-
tween 24-48 hours
3. Nose blowing is avoided as it could cause em-
physema of cheek area
4. If patient uses denture then it should not be
worn for at least a week to facilitate mucosal
healing
Complications:
166
week.
2. Injury to infra orbital nerve causing anesthesia
of upper teeth and lateral wall of nose. It can even
cause pain and numbness over the face
3. Injury to nasolacrimal duct while performing
inferior meatal antrostomy
4. Devitalization of teeth due to injury to its root
Introduction:
Nasal decongestion:
Since the introduction of Functional endoscopic
surgery inferior meatal antrostomy as a procedure Nasal mucosa is decongested by using pledgets
has taken a back seat due to the apprehension soaked in 4% xylocaine mixed with 1 in 10,000
that it could tamper with the normal mucocil- adrenaline. The pledget should be squeezed dry
iary clearance mechanism. In fact studies per- before insertion. This is done to avoid xylocaine
formed in 1980’s reported that if inferior meatal over dosage. Pledgets should be placed in inferi-
antrostomy is created the mucous bridges across or meatus, floor of the nasal cavity, and middle
the antrostomy and travels towards the natural meatus. If general anesthesia is used throat pack
ostium of the maxillary sinus. This can utmost be should be given to prevent aspiration.
considered to be only partially true. Current stud-
ies have demonstrated that drainage of mucous Infiltration:
does occur via the opening created in the inferior
meatus. 2% xylocaine with `1 in 100,000 units adrenaline
is used to infiltrate the inferior turbinate and the
Current indications for inferior meatal antrosto- corresponding portion of nasal septum. 0 degree
my: nasal endoscope is
1. Patients with chronic sinusitis not responding used for purposes of visualization. A Freer’s
to FESS elevator is inserted into the inferior meatus and
2. Patients in whom mucociliary clearance is the inferior turbinate is up fractured so that it lies
already affected due to cystic fibrosis / Young’s perpendicular to the floor of the nasal cavity. This
syndrome. These patients usually benefit from procedure is a must for adequate visualization of
inferior meatal antrostomy the inferior meatal area. The location of Hasner’s
3. Mycetoma present in the maxillary sinus cavity valve (lower end of nasolacrimal duct) is identi-
4. To visualize the difficult to see areas inside fied at the junction of anterior third and middle
maxillary sinus cavity third of the lateral nasal wall.
5. When regular post op surveillance is needed
6. During Caldwell Luc procedure antral packing A 90 degree angled J curette is ideal to perform
is done via the inferior meatal antrostomy created antrostomy. The lateral nasal wall is perforated
towards the end of the surgery with J curette about 1 cm posterior to Hasner’s
valve. The opening is then enlarged with the help
Endoscopic inferior meatal antrostomy: of back biting forceps. Now insertion of a 30 de-
gree nasal endoscope will help in better visualiza-
Nasal endoscope is a very useful tool for otolar- tion of the interior of maxillary sinus cavity.
yngologist. By using this tool the whole procedure
can be performed under direct visualization. This
168
Image showing the inferior meatus after medial-
ising the inferior turbinate Image showing inferior meatal opening
Complications
4. Bleeding
1. Helps / facilitates dependent drainage of max- Inferior meatal antrostomy with mucosal flap:
illary sinus in the presence of secondary ciliary
dysfunction which is a feature in persistent maxil- This procedure helps in keeping the inferior me-
lary sinus infections. atal antrostomy opening patent for a long period
of time. Keeping the antrostomy opening patent
2. It provides alternate drainage pathway to the for long durations is a necessity when the patient
maxillary sinus till the ciliary mechanism be- is suffering from primary mucociliary disorders
comes functional. preventing effective clearance of secretions from
the maxillary antrum. The sinus thus depends on
3. It helps in removal of polypoidal tissue from gravity and a patent inferior meatal antrostomy to
the maxillary sinus antrum. keep the drainage process going. Patent opening
also would be helpful if periodical viewing of the
4. Useful in breaking large retention cysts present antral cavity is needed.
in the maxillary sinus antrum.
Procedure
5. Facilitates removal of fungal debris from the
maxillary sinus cavity Under GA/LA the nasal cavity is decongest-
ed first using cotton pledgets dipped in 0.05%
6. Helps in the process of irrigation to remove oxymetazoline. Specifically the inferior meatal
thick and tenacious secretions that could be pres- area is decongested. A Freer elevator is sued to
ent within the sinus cavity. medialize the inferior turbinate.
7. Large permanent antrostomy is indicated in As a first step the lower end of naso lacrimal
patients with primary ciliary dysfunction duct (Hasner’s valve area) is identified under the
inferior turbinate. It lies roughly 15 mm above
The effectiveness of an antral window in treat- the floor of the nasal cavity and 4-6 mm poste-
ing maxillary sinusitis and the precise location rior to the anterior end of the inferior turbinate.
of such a window has always been controversial. A monopolar cautery probe or 15 blade knife is
Hilding suggested that creation of an inferior used to make an incision below and anterior to
meatal window could be detrimental to long-term the Hasner’s valve. Mucoperiosteal flap is ele-
mucociliary clearance. On the other hand Fried- vated with a Freer elevator. The inferior portion
man and Torimumi demonstrated with radio- of the medial wall of maxillary sinus is opened
nuclide studies that inferior meatal antrostomy using a Miles retrograde gouge at the level of the
does not hinder mucociliary clearance towards mucosal incision. The opening can be widened
maxillary sinus natural ostium. Studies have also using a cutting burr. After the process of widen-
revealed that widening of natural ostium leads to ing is completed then the mucosal flap is inserted
some disruption of the normal mucociliary clear- in such a way that it covers the lower border of
170
Image showing inferior meatal mucosal flap procedure. (a) The U-shaped mucosal flap was positioned
on the nasal floor after the elevation from the meatal bone; (b) The flap was positioned across the
inferior lip of the bony window into the maxillary sinus after removing bony wall. NLD, Nasolacrimal
Duct. IT, Inferior Turbinate. MT, Middle Turbinate.
Pulse reactors – These patients showed changes in Image showing Murray Falconer
pulse rate in response to emotional stress
Nose reactors – These patients manifested with Murray Falconer’s petrosal neurectomy:
nasal congestion and discharge following emo-
tional stress. He performed this surgery under Local anesthe-
sia. The whole procedure was performed while
the patient is seated up.
172
Incision: the medial pterygoid plate. The mobilization of
mucoperichondrium extends forwards over the
Vertical incision is made above the zygoma one perpendicular plate of palatine bone. The spheno-
inch in front of the external auditory meatus. The palatine foramen comes into view and is identi-
temporalis muscle was split and the squamous fied and the vidian nerve is blindly cauterized as
portion of the temporal bone was exposed. A burr it exits from the foramen.
hole was performed in the squamous portion of
the temporal bone and the opening is enlarged till Golding – Wood’s transantral approach:
the floor of the middle cranial fossa is exposed.
The middle cranial fossa dura is gently stripped Inspired by the work of Malcomson Golding
from the floor and retracted with the help of wood started to work on the various approaches
retractors. While stripping the dura from the to vidian nerve. He popularized the transantral
middle cranial fossa it could be found attached vidian neurectomy. He considered it to be a rather
firmly to the foramen spinosum. This area could safe procedure in comparison to intracranial ap-
bleed during the dissection. The middle meninge- proach to the nerve popularized by Malcomson.
al artery which traverses this foramen was co-
agulated and cut. The foramen is plugged. From
now on the dura strips easily and the mandibular
division of trigeminal nerve is identified entering
the foramen ovale which lies medial and slightly
anterior to foramen spinosum. On stripping the
dura from the anteromedial face of petrous bone
the greater superficial petrosal nerve can be clear-
ly seen. Without causing any traction the nerve is
divided.
This is a rather blind approach. As a first step a Image showing Golding Wood
submucosal resection of nasal septum was per-
formed. The rostrum of sphenoid is identified. In
this area the muco-periosteum is elevated off the
anterior and inferior faces of the body of sphe-
noid. The mobilization of the mucoperiosteum is
continued laterally over to the medial surface of
Golding-Wood in his classic paper on the role of Nerves that gets involved in the formation of
vidian neurectomy in the treatment of crocodile vidian nerve:
tears in 1963 observed “The only animal capable
of weeping in sorrow is the human with a doubt- 1. Greater petrosal nerve (preganglionic parasym-
ful exception to elephant.” This was in fact the pathetic fibers)
classic observation of Charles Darwin. 2. Deep petrosal nerve (post ganglionic sympa-
thetic fibers)
Effects of vidian nerve stimulation on nasal mu- 3. Ascending sphenoidal branch from otic gan-
cosa: glion Vidian nerve is formed at the junction of
greater petrosal and deep petrosal nerves.
“The parasympathetic innervation of the nasal
mucosa play a prominent role in the pathogene- This area is located in the cartilaginous substance
sis of chronic hypertrophic non allergic rhinitis”. which fills the foramen lacerum. From this area
Golding-Wood 1961. it passes forward through the pterygoid canal ac-
The vidian nerve provides the main parasympa- companied by artery of pterygoid canal. It is here
thetic supply to the nasal mucosa and maxillary the ascending branch from the otic ganglion joins
sinus mucosa. Stimulation of this nerve causes this nerve.
secretory and vasodilatory effects in animals.
The vidian nerve exits its bony canal in the ptery-
gopalatine fossa where it joins the pterygopalatine
ganglion.
174
Vidian canal: The parasympathetic fibers to the nasal muco-
sa enters the nose through the sphenopalatine
It is through this canal the vidian nerve passes. foramen. At the level of sphenopalatine ganglion
This is a short bony tunnel seen close to the floor the parasympathetic fibers synapse. Post synaptic
of sphenoid sinus. This canal transmits the vidian parasympathetic fibers from the sphenopalatine
nerve and vidian vessels from the foramen lace- ganglion arise at the pterygopalatine fossa. These
rum to the pterygopalatine fossa. post synaptic fibers are three in number. They are:
According to CT scan findings the vidian canal is 1. Nasal nerve – innervating the nasal mucosa
classified into: 2. Lacrimal nerve – innervating the lacrimal
gland
Type I: The vidian canal lies completely within 3. Greater palatine nerve – innervating the palate.
the floor of sphenoid sinus
176
Anatomy of sphenopalatine foramen: Indication for vidian neurectomy:
178
Transnasal preganglionic vidian neurectomy:
180
wall. Endoscopic intrasphenoidal vidian neurecto-
Blanching of the area indicates adequate infiltra- my:
tion.
The preparation of patient for this procedure is
similar to that of Endoscopic sinus surgery. The
nasal cavity is decongested using a mixture of 4%
xylocaine with 1 in
10,000 adrenaline soaked pledgets.
Image showing sphenopalatine artery exiting out Image showing sphenopalatine nerve
of sphenopalatine foramen
182
Complications of vidian neurectomy: sphenopalatine foramen is widened towards the
anterior face of sphenoid. The thin anterior wall
1. Dry eye due to decreased lacrimation of sphenoid sinus is penetrated using the Freer’s
2. Neurotorphic keratopathy elevator. The floor of the sphenoid sinus should
3. Ocular movement disturbances be visualized to study the course of the vidian
4. Blindness nerve.
Endoscopic vidian neurectomy: The vidian canal lies at the junction between the
floor of the sphenoid sinus and the lateral nasal
This procedure is performed under endoscopic wall. The vidian canal should not be confused
vision. Patient preparation is the same as for other with that of palatovaginal canal. Palatovaginal
endoscopic sinus surgical procedures. A curved canal which contains pharyngeal branches of the
suction tip is used to maxillary artery and pterygopalatine ganglion lies
palpate the lateral nasal wall behind the uncinate inferomedial to the vidian canal. The vidian nerve
and above the insertion of the inferior turbinate is exposed, resected and bleeders if any is coagu-
in order to identify the soft membranous portion lated.
of the posterior
fontanelle of the maxilla. On moving the suction Treatment of crocodile tears with vidian neu-
tip posterior to the posterior fontanelle, the hard rectomy:
bony anterior edge of palatine bone can be identi-
fied. A C shaped incision is made using a 15 blade This term crocodile tears was coined by Bogorad
at the junction between the posterior fontanelle to describe the unusual phenomenon of profuse
and the palatine bone. The incision starts just lacrimation which occurs during eating only. He
below the horizontal portion of the basal lamella coined this term because it was believed croco-
and ends just above the insertion of inferior tur- diles shed tears before devouring their prey. This
binate in the lateral nasal wall. condition could be a sequel to facial palsy.
Caution: The incision should not extend into the Other causes of crocodile tears include:
maxillary sinus via the posterior fontanelle.
1. Head injury
A posterior based mucoperiosteal flap is raised 2. Operative trauma
using a Freer’s elevator, exposing the palatine 3. Syphilitic lesion of geniculate ganglion
bone. During 3-4 mm of dissection the flap is
raised over the entire length of the incision. After This condition occurs due to anomalous regen-
this level the flap is raised only along the lower eration causing the secretomotor fibers from the
third of the incision i.e. just above the insertion of corda tympani nerve reaches the lacrimal gland
the inferior turbinate. This dissection is continued via the greater superficial petrosal nerve.
posteriorly till the anterior face of sphenoid sinus
is reached. Now the dissection proceeds upwards
exposing the ethmoidal crest and the underlying
sphenopalatine artery. The posterior rim of the
184
Approaches to frontal sinus tomical constraints.
History of frontal sinus surgery History of frontal sinus surgery can be divided
into following era:
The first frontal sinus procedure was described in
1750. Despite more than two centuries since the 1. Era of trephination (1750)
description of the first procedure on frontal sinus,
the optimal procedure to access frontal sinus still 2. Era of radical ablation procedures (1895)
remains unclear. The frontal sinus surgery makes
up only a small portion of all surgeries involving 3. Era of conservative procedures (1905)
paranasal sinuses. Ellis in 1954 stated that “surgi-
cal treatment of chronic frontal sinusitis is diffi- 4. External fronto-ethmoidectomy (1897-1921)
cult, often unsatisfactory and sometimes disas-
trous. The sheer number of surgical techniques 5. Osteoplastic anterior wall approach (1958)
available are expressions of our uncertainty and
perhaps also our failure.” 6. Endoscopic intranasal approach
Osteoplastic flap has been the mainstay of surgi- Radical ablation procedures (1895)
cal access to the frontal sinus. With advances in
the field of imaging and endoscopy, a new fron- During this era a number of physicians were
tier (intranasal approach) has become popular. advocating a radical procedure to clear frontal
Assessing the frontal sinus is a greater surgical sinus disease. In 1895 Kuhnt described a proce-
challenge than other sinuses owing to the ana- dure where in he removed the anterior wall of the
186
show evidence of frontal trephination.
Procedure:
Anesthesia:
188
It represents superior and lateral pneumatization
Resection of agger nasi and anterosuperior of the anterior ethmoidal cell. This accounts for
attachment of the middle turbinate is needed the significant variation in frontal sinus anato-
to create a widely patent frontal recess. Ostium my. These include variations such as agger nasi
probe / ball probe is used to locate the outflow cell penumatization, prominent ethmoidal bullae
tract. The nasofrontal beak which is shelf like and supraorbital cells. Ethmoidal air cells may
bony process anterior to the frontal outflow tract be contained wholly within the frontal recess /
can be removed using a Kerrison rongeur / drill / frontal sinus and are termed frontal cells.
curette.
Bent’s classification of accessory frontal cells:
Further drainage would require removal of the
superior aspect of the nasal septum, this is need- The classification proposed by Bent grouped
ed if a bilateral frontal sinus drill out is desired. these cells into four different types based on their
In order to allow re-epithelialization, the surgeon location.
must not remove the posterior table mucosa.
Mucosal preservation is of utmost importance in Type I: This type represents a single frontal cell
routine, uncomplicated frontal sinus surgery. just above the agger nasi cell
A frontal sinus stent can be used in more compli- Type II: This type consists of a tier of two or more
cated cases where mucosal preservation may be air cells superior to the agger nasi cell.
difficult and typically when the neo-ostium is less
than 5 mm in diameter. Type III: This type has a single frontal cell which
is massive and it pneumatizes superiorly into the
FESS can also be used with trephination in the frontal sinus
presence of thick secretions, high frontal cells
within the sinus, and lateralized frontal sinus Type IV: These cells are contained entirely within
disease. Extended drainage of the sinus can be the frontal sinus, thus giving it a cell inside a cell
achieved by means of resection of the frontal appearance.
sinus floor.
Among these types III and IV are considered to
be invasive types.
190
dibulum are cleared first. This procedure involves
removing the superior portion of the uncinate Draf 2 Procedure
process, the anterior ethmoid cells and cells with-
in the frontal recess. Agger nasi cell is preserved Draf 2A and 2B procedures differ from Draf 1
in Draf 1 procedure. In this procedure the nar- procedure in that all cells within the frontal sinus
rowest part of the frontal recess is not manipulat- are cleared with direct opening of the internal
ed, structures inferior to the internal frontal sinus frontal sinus ostium. In Draf 2A procedure all
ostium are cleared. cells within the frontal recess lateral to the middle
turbinate attachment are opened in addition to
the structures cleared in Draf 1 procedure. A large
number of primary cases and many revision cases
as well can be addressed by Draf 2 technique.
192
Image showing agger nasi air cell after deroofing Image showing the deroofed agger nasi and the
frontal outflow tract that lies medial to it. The
lateral wall of agger nasi should be removed to
clear the area
194
scans)
Frontal sinus rescue
5. 65 degrees mushroom punch is useful in fron-
This procedure was first described by Citardi in tal recess dissection
1997. This was considered to be an alternative to
Draf 3 procedure / external frontal sinus oblit- 6. Hosemann punch which is an angulated mush-
eration in certain situations. This procedure is room punch with greater cutting strength is use-
intended to correct iatrogenic scarring of the ful for clearing osteitic bone from frontal recess.
frontal ostium making the sinus safe by prevent-
ing mucocele formation. The technique of this 7. Bachert / cobra forceps can be used to clear
procedure involves transposing a laterally based agger nasi and frontal recess cells
mucosal flap from the middle turbinate rem-
nant on to the medial skull base. A longitudinal 8. Powered instrumentation with angled drills is
incision is made in the middle turbinate remnant typically used when performing extended endo-
and lateral mucosal flaps are raised. The medial scopic approaches like that of Draf 3 procedure.
flap is resected along with the continuous mu-
cosa on the anterior skull base. The bony middle
turbinate remnant is then resected. The lateral
flap is then turned into the area of the previously
resected mucosa along the anterior skull base.
This procedure has the advantage of changing
the circumferential scar of the frontal duct into a
geometrical pattern for prevention of recurrent
scar formation.
196
tomy, osteoplastic flap with obliteration of frontal
sinus could be used to treat lesions of frontal 4. Complicated acute frontal sinusitis
sinus.
5. Pott’s puffy tumor
Patients with pathology in frontal sinus whose le-
sions are inaccessible with endoscope by endona- 6. Lateral frontal sinus mucocele
sal approach alone should be considered for this
approach. Preoperative evaluation which include 7. Repair of frontal sinus CSF leak
CT and MRI should be performed to ascertain
the suitability of the procedure. 8. Removal of osteoma
A mini brow incision is made lateral to the su- Classic frontoethmoidectomy involves removing
praorbital foramen. Periosteum is incised and the lamina papyracea, opening and stripping the
the underlying bone is exposed. In case of CSF mucosa from the ethmoid sinuses up to cribri-
leak from the posterior table of the frontal sinus form plate, nibbling away the lateral wall of the
a bony window is made with 4 mm cutting burr frontonasal duct and floor of frontal sinus and
in the anterior wall of frontal sinus which can be stripping the mucosa from the frontal sinus.
enlarged as per requirement. Maximum width
of the window should not exceed 10 mm. The The classic external frontoethmoidectomy howev-
endoscope is inserted through the brow incision er is contrary to modern principles of endoscopic
and the interior of frontal sinus is examined. This sinus surgery which include:
window can be used to secure access to the fron-
tal sinus cavity. 1. Limiting surgery to diseased sinuses
External approaches to frontal and ethmoid 3. Avoiding surgery to the frontal recess and fron-
sinuses are rarely used these days. This procedure tonasal duct
is performed only in centers in the developing
world where endoscopic sinus surgery expertise 4. Preserving middle turbinate
and instrumentation are not available.
5. Limiting resection of lamina papyracea to avoid
Indications for open approaches: medial prolapse of orbital soft tissues
3. Biopsy of tumors
198
not been any problems with persistent diplopia
as a result of this. Soft tissues over the nose on
the medial edge of the incision are elevated to the
midline of the nasal dorsum and caudally to the
end of the ipsilateral nasal bone, thereby exposing
the entire ipsilateral nasal bone.
Step 2:
Step 4
200
Endoscopic frontal sinus surgery (Agger nasi
approach)
Procedure
I Image
Endoscopic frontal sinus surgery is performed
under general anesthesia. Patient is positioned Image showing the incision over the agger nasi
supine in the operating table with the head slight- area
ly lowered. The operative procedure is usually
performed using image guidance using a wide
angled 0 degree nasal endoscope. Incision is
positioned over the agger mucosa. The mucosa is
separated to expose the bony surface of the fron-
tomaxillary process and attachment of the middle
turbinate. The bone of frontomaxillary process is
drilled directly upward between the orbital plate
of the ethmoid bone and attachment of the mid-
dle turbinate. The bone of frontomaxillary pro-
cess is directly drilled out upwards between the
orbital plate of ethmoid bone and attachment of
middle turbinate using angled diamond burrs and
then the anterior upper attachment of uncinate
process and agger cells should be fully visualized.
After removal of fragile partitions of uncinate
process, frontal recess, agger cells are removed
with curettes or fine forceps under direct visual- Image showing opening being created in the floor
ization the floor of frontal sinus is identified and of the frontal sinus under endoscopic vision.
resected using an angled diamond burr to create
a more than 6 mm frontal drainage pathway. En-
doscopic management of ethmoid, maxillary and
sphenoid sinus is performed as needed.
Introduction:
202
8. To determine whether an infection has moved patient to swallow. The endoscope is now turned
beyond the sinuses 90 degrees in the opposite direction, the uvula
9. To diagnose chronic recurrent sinusitis in chil- and soft palate comes into view. The endoscope is
dren with asthma again rotated by 90 degrees in the same direction,
10. To diagnose reason for anosmia (loss of the opposite side pharyngeal end of eustachean
smell). tube is visualised. In this field both eustachean
11. To evaluate any discharges from the nasal tubes become visible.
cavities like CSF.
12. To diagnose reason for facial pain / headaches. Second pass:
Procedure: Topical anesthetic 4% xylocaine is
used to anesthetise the nasal cavity before the After the first pass is over, the scope is gently
procedure. About 7 ml of 4% xylocaine is mixed withdrawn out and slide medial to the middle
with 10 drops of xylometazoline. Cotton pledgets turbinate. The relation ship between the mid-
are dipped in the solution, squeezed dry and used dle turbinate and nasal septum is studied. This
to pack the nasal cavity. Pledgets are packed in relationship is classified as TS1, TS2, and TS3.
the inferior, middle and superior meati. Packs are It depends on whether, after application of de-
left in place for full 5 minutes. Diagnostic endos- congestant both the medial and lateral surfaces
copy is performed using a 30 degree nasal endo- of the middle turbinate is visible (TS1), part of
scope. If 2.7 mm scope is available it is preferred the middle turbinate is obscured by septal devi-
because it can reach the smallest crevices of the ation (TS2), or the septal deviation is completely
nose. 4mm endoscope is sufficient to examine obscures the middle turbinate (TS3). The scope is
adult nasal cavities. gently slipped medial to the middle turbinate. The
sphenoid ostium comes into view. Secretions if
The process of examination can be divided into any from the ostium is noted.
three passes:
Third pass:
1. First pass / inferior pass
2. Second pass Is the most important of all the three passes. This
3. Third pass. pass studies the crucial middle turbinate area.
The middle turbinate is evaluated for its shape
First pass: and size as well as its relationship to the lateral
nasal wall and septum. A bulge just above and
In this the endoscope is introduced along the anterior to the attachment of the middle turbinate
floor of the nasal cavity. Middle turbinate is the suggests an enlarged agger nasi cells. Sometimes
first structure to come into view. Its superior the anterior tip of the middle turbinate may be
attachment is studied. Inferior surface of the mid- triangular. This shape has no significance unless
dle turbinate is studied. As the endoscope is slid it causes obstruction to the middle meatus. A
posteriorly the adenoid tissue comes into view. middle turbinate that is concave medially rather
On the lateral surface of the nasopharynx the than laterally is considered paradoxical. But par-
pharyngeal end of eustachean tube can be iden- adoxical turbinate which is symptomatic needs
tified. Its function can be assessed by asking the to be treated. If the middle turbinate is enlarged
204
Image showing sphenoid ostium
206
is incised and the zygoma, frontal bone, superior
and lateral orbital margins, nasal bone and part Disadvantages
of parietal and temporal bone are exposed. When
hemicoronal incision is planned, this incision will a) Loss of hair due to injury to hair follicle in the
be stopped just short of midline. incision line
b) Poor scar in case of male type baldness
c) Inadequate access to middle third of facial
skeleton
d)Excessive haemorrhage
e) Potential for damage of temporal branch of
facial nerve resulting in weakness of frontalis
muscle.
f) Post-operative hematoma due to wide dissec-
tion of scalp
g) Sensory disturbance, anaesthesia or paresthesia
affecting supraorbital and preauricular region.
h) Trismus, ptosis and epiphora are also reported.
Advantages
208
cells
FESS
Aim of FESS:
Introduction:
1. Disease clearance
FESS is the acronym for Functional Endoscopic
Sinus Surgery. This procedure has revolutionized 2. Improvement of drainage
the management of sinus infections to such an
extent the hitherto commonly performed antral Instruments:
lavage has been relegated to history.
1. Nasal endoscope
Middle meatus area: This is a crucial area for the
drainage of anterior group of sinuses. Any pa- 2. Camera (endo)
thology in this area could effectively compromise
this rather critical drainage process. The success 3. Monitor
of FESS depends on how effectively this area is
cleared. 4. Surgical instruments
210
sified into three types depending on its superior to the ethmoidal infundibulum.
attachment. The anterior incision of the uncinate
is not clearly identifiable as it is covered with mu-
cosa which is continuous with that of the lateral
nasal wall. Sometimes a small groove is visible
over the area where the uncinate process attaches
itself to the lateral nasal wall.
Classic uncinectomy:
212
After the incision using a sickle knife the unci-
nate is medialized and removed using a Blakesley
forceps (straight one). Small tags especially the
inferior portion of the uncinate can be removed
using a 45 degree Blakesley forceps. The free edge
of the uncinate process should be grasped for
total removal. It can be removed by a medial turn
of the forceps towards the nasal septum. Removal
of uncinate process opens up the middle meatus
of the nasal cavity.
214
Complications:
1. Bleeding
2. Injury to orbital contents
3. Injury to lacrimal duct (seen in swing door
technique when using back biting forceps).
216
Image showing posterior ethmoidal cells exposed Image showing basal lamella perforated
after perforating the basal lamella which is the
horizontal portion of the middle turbinate. Posterior ethmoids are dissected until the anteri-
or face of the sphenoid sinus is reached. The skull
base is identified. Further dissection will lead on
to the sphenoid sinus.
2. Recurrent sinusitis
3. Nasal polyposis
Image showing J curette being used to perforate
the basal lamella in the medial and inferior 4. Antrochoanal polyp
portion.
5. Sinus mucoceles
1. Intraorbital complications of acute sinusitis i.e. As the endoscope is further advanced into the
orbital abscess, frontal osteomyelitis etc. An open nasal cavity the middle turbinate becomes visi-
approach, with or without the assistance of endo- ble. This is the key landmark in endoscopic sinus
scopic vision is preferable in these cases. surgery. It has two components i.e. the vertical
component lying in the sagittal plane, running
2. After two failures of endoscopic surgery to from posterior to anterior, and a horizontal com-
manage CSF leak. ponent lying in the coronal plane, running from
medial to lateral. This horizontal component
3. Failure to manage endoscopically frontal sinus separates the middle ethmoid air cells from the
disease is an indication for open procedure. posterior ethmoids. This portion is also known as
the basal lamella. A surgeon needs to breech the
Applied anatomy basal lamella to reach the posterior ethmoid air
cells. Superiorly the middle turbinate attaches to
Immediately on entering the nasal cavity the first the skull base at the cribriform plate, hence care
structures encountered are the nasal septum and should be taken while manipulating the middle
inferior turbinate. The nasal septum is made up turbinate as it could lead to microfractures in the
of quadrangular cartilage anteriorly, this extends cribriform plate area causing CSF rhinorrhoea.
up to the perpendicular plate of ethmoid bone
posterosuperiorly and the vomer bone posteroin-
feriorly.
218
Image showing deviated nasal septum as viewed Image showing uncinate process
through an endoscope
Natural ostium of maxillary sinus
Image showing natural ostium of maxillary sinus Image showing suprabullar recess
indicated by curved black arrow. Bulla and mid-
dle turbinate (MT) are also marked. Ethmoid air cells
The lateral extent of the bulla is the lamina papy- Exenteration of the posterior ethmoidal cells
racea. Superiorly, the ethmoid bulla may extend exposes the face of the sphenoid. The sphenoid
all the way up to the ethmoid roof. Sometimes sinus is the most posterior of all paranasal si-
a suprabullar recess could exist above the roof of nuses, sitting just superior to nasopharynx and
the bulla. A careful preoperative review of the just anterior and inferior to the sella turcica. The
patient’s CT scan clarifies this relationship. anterior face of the sphenoid sits approximately 7
cm from the nasal cavity opening on a 30 degree
axis from the horizontal.
220
to grasp the free uncinate edge and to remove it.
Many important structures are related to the Instead of a sickle knife a back biting forceps can
sphenoid sinus. The internal carotid artery is typ- be used to remove the uncinate process.
ically the most posterior and medial impression
seen within the sphenoid sinus. Bone lining over
this artery could be dehiscent in some cases. Maxillary antrostomy
The optic nerve and its bony encasement produc- Once the uncinate process is removed the natural
es an anterosuperior indentation within the roof ostium will come into view. Ipsilateral eye can be
of the sphenoid sinus. In 4% of cases, the bone palpated to ensure that there is no dehiscence of
surrounding the optic nerve could be dehiscent. lamina papyracea and also to confirm the loca-
It is necessary for controlled opening of the tion of the lamina. The natural ostium is typically
sphenoid sinus, typically at its natural ostium is situated at the level of the inferior edge of the
critical for a safe surgery. middle turbinate about one third of the way back.
Location of the natural ostium of the sphenoid True cutting instrument is used to circumfer-
sinus is variable. In approximately 60% of per- entially enlarge the natural ostium. Optimal
sons, the ostium is located medial to the superior diameter of the maxillary antrostomy is not clear.
turbinate and in 40% it could be located lateral to A diameter of 1 cm would allow for adequate
the superior turbinate. outflow and for post operative monitoring in
the office. Care should be taken not to penetrate
lamina papyracea.
Endoscopic uncinectomy
Anterior ethmoidectomy
Functional endoscopic sinus surgery usually
begins with uncinectomy. If the uncinate process The ethmoid bulla is identified and opened
can be visualized without manipulation of mid- next. a J curette could be used to open the bulla
dle turbinate, uncinectomy can be performed at its inferior and medial aspect. Once the cell
directly. Otherwise, middle turbinate is gently is entered, the bony portions may be carefully
medialized, carefully using the curved portion of removed using a microdebrider or true cutting
the Freer elevator to avoid mucosal injury to the forceps. Complete resection of lateral portion
turbinate. Forceful medialization and fracture of of bulla facilitates proper visualization and dis-
the turbinate should be avoided. section posteriorly. While working laterally care
should be taken to maintain an intact lamina
Uncinectomy can be performed via an incision papyracea.
with either the sharp end of the Freer elevator or
a sickle knife. Thee incision should be placed at The rest of the anterior ethmoid cells can be un-
the most anterior portion of the uncinate process, capped with a J curette and further opened with
which is softer on palpation in comparison with a microdebrider or a true cutting forceps. Initial
the firmer lacrimal bone where the nasolacrimal use of curette usually allows for tactile sensa-
duct is located. Then a Blakesley forceps is used tion and determination of the thickness of the
Posterior ethmoidectomy
222
Image showing location of natural ostium after Image showing anterior ethmoidectomy com-
removal of horizontal portion of the lower unci- pleted demonstrating frontal recess, vertical and
nate process horizontal segments of middle turbinate
1. Bleeding
2. Synechiae formation
3. Orbital injury
4. Diplopia
5. Orbital hematoma
224
tions following ethmoidal sinusitis which include
External ethmoidectomy orbital cellulitis, orbital subperiosteal abscess,
orbital abscess, superior orbital fissure syndrome
Ethmoidal sinusitis is one of the most compli- and cavernous sinus thrombosis.
cated pathologies in ear / nose / throat practice.
Because of its critical location, ethmoidal sinusitis 3. Managing chronic ethmoidal sinusitis in areas
can become really dangerous and difficult con- where facilities for endoscopic sinus surgery is
dition to treat. Types of surgical interventions not available.
include:
Procedure
1. Intranasal ethmoidectomy using nasal endo-
scope This surgery is ideally performed under General
anesthesia because manipulating the globe can be
2. External ethmoidectomy uncomfortable for the patient. Incision, a curvi-
linear one about 3 cm long is made at the mid-
3. Transantral ethmoidectomy point between the medial canthus and the middle
of the anterior nasal bone. The skin is incised,
Ethmoid sinuses begin their development during and the dissection is carried down to the perios-
infancy and continue to expand during the early teum. The angular artery could come in the way
childhood. The ethmoid sinuses are paired struc- and should be transected and ligated. Dissection
tures, and are divided into anterior and posterior is carried subperiosteally to the posterior lacrimal
ethmoidal cells. The division is provided by the crest, avoiding damage to the lacrimal excretory
basal lamella of the middle turbinate. Ethmoid structures. The medial canthal tendon may need
sinuses in adults have an average length of 4.5 cm to be released, to allow an easier access to this
and a height of approximately 3 cm. area. If this is done care must be taken to reposi-
tion it correctly. The posterior crest may need to
Walls of ethmoid sinus are composed of max- be removed. Dissection can be extended supe-
illary, palatine, frontal, lacrimal and sphenoid riorly to the frontoethmoid suture as this is the
bones. Lateral to the sinus lies the lamina papyr- demarcation between the ethmoid and anterior
acea and superiorly is the fovea ethmoidalis. Ulti- cranial fossa.
mate drainage pathway for secretions from ante-
rior ethmoidal cells is the osteomeatal complex in Complications
the middle meatus. The posterior ethmoidal cells
drain into the superior meatus. 1. Cutaneous scar could lead to medial canthal
webbing, telecanthus, and medial canthal dys-
Indications for surgery topia, especially if the medial canthal tendon is
released and not properly positioned.
1. Patients who have not responded to medical
therapy for 3-6 weeks duration 2. Periorbital oedema, injury to extraocular mus-
cles with diplopia, parathesias in the distribution
2. Patients who have developed orbital complica- of the supraorbital, supratrochlear, and infrat-
3. Globe injury
226
the advent of CT scan x-ray paranasal sinuses was
Endoscopic Management of Fronto ethmoidal the only diagnostic tool available. X-ray would
mucocele usually reveal the loss of normal haustrations
found in the frontal sinus. Infact it was even con-
A mucocele is an epithelium lined mucous con- sidered pathognomonic.
taining sac. It usually develops when the sinus os-
tium gets obstructed by chronic sinusitis, polyps Using a 4mm 0° nasal endoscope the surgery is
or tumors. These mucoceles are known to erode performed. The complete surgery was performed
the bone and may involve the brain and orbit. It under general anesthesia. On deroofing the agger
may also present as a forehead mass with pro- nasi cell the contents of the mucocele started to
ptosis as in this patient. Classification of Frontal extrude. The frontal sinus ostium was widened.
mucocele: When the scope was introduced through the
widened frontal ostium the posterior table of the
Frontal mucoceles have been classified into 5 frontal sinus was found to be eroded. The frontal
types depending on its extent. lobe of the brain was clearly visible. The brain
can be identified by its characteristic pulsations
Type I: In this type the mucocele is limited to the coinciding with the patient’s respiration.
frontal sinus only with or without orbital exten-
sion. Type II: Here the mucocele is found involv- The major advantages of endoscopic approach are
ing the frontal and ethmoidal sinuses with or
without orbital extension. 1. The procedure has minimal risk
Type IIIa: In this type the mucocele erodes the 2. There is no scar
posterior wall of the frontal sinus with minimal
or no intracranial involvement. 3. Intranasal drainage path can be created
Type IIIb: In this type the mucocele erodes the 4. Minimal complications
posterior wall with major intra cranial extension.
228
TESPAL (Trans nasal endoscopic sphenopala-
tine artery ligation)
History:
Indication:
2. Posterior epistaxis
Procedure:
Image showing the position of sphenopalatine
The nose should first be adequately decongest- artery
ed topically using 4% xylocaine mixed with 1 in
50,000 units adrenaline.
Incision:
An incision ranging between 10 - 20 mm is made
vertically about 5 mm anterior to the attachment
of the middle turbinate. The mucosal flap is gently
retracted posteriorly till the crista ethmoidalis is
visualized. The crista ethmoidalis is a reliable land
mark for the sphenopalatine artery. The artery en-
ters the nose just posterior to the crista. The crista
can in fact be removed using a Kerrison’s punch Image showing wide antrostomy performed
for better visualization of the artery.
230
Following successful ligation / cauterization, the
area is explored posteriorly for 2 - 3 mm to ensure
that no more vessels remain uncauterized.
Complications of TESPAL:
1. Palatal numbness
2. Sinusitis
3. Decreased lacrimation
4. Septal perforation
5. Inferior turbinate necrosis
History: Contraindications:
Hippocrates was the first to note the association 1. Complete disruption of optic nerve or chiasma
of trauma just above the eyebrow and gradual vi- 2. Complete atrophy of the nerve
sion loss. During the 18th century the association 3. Carotid cavernous fistula
between frontal trauma and loss of vision without
evidence of ocular injury was very well appreci- Surgical anatomy:
ated. It was Battle in 1890 who distinguished the
difference between penetrating direct injury from Optic canal:
non penetrating indirect optic nerve injuries. The optic nerve enters the optic canal at the su-
20th century saw significant progress in classifica- peromedial corner of the orbital apex. This canal
tion, pathophysiology and management of is about 10 mm long. It contains the optic nerve,
optic nerve injuries. ophthalmic artery and sympathetic plexus.
Historically three treatment modalities have been Lateral – Optic canal is separated from the supe-
232
rior orbital fissure by a bony ridge known as the
optic strut.
Ophthalmic artery:
234
Pathophysiology of optic neuropathy: prognosis.
It is rather poorly understood. Some of the ac- Traumatic optic neuropathy is the most common
cepted facts include: indication for optic nerve decompression. De-
1. Optic nerve avulsion compression is ideally considered only in cases
2. Optic nerve sheath hematoma where there is a displaced fracture of the optic
3. Penetrating FB or bony fracture canal, with no evidence of anatomical disruption
of the nerve. In patients with preserved light
Traumatic optic neuropathy is an indirect event perception surgical decompression is considered
that occurs shortly after or during blunt trauma with / without administration of steroids.
to the superior orbital rim, lateral orbital rim,
frontal area or the cranium. This is postulated to Timing of intervention is also controversial,
occur due to transmitted forces via the orbital but ideally speaking decompression should be
bones to done as soon as possible after optic neuropathy
the orbital apex and optic canal. Elastic deforma- is diagnosed, and especially so if it is of sudden
tion forces of the sphenoid bone allows transfer onset. In patients with traumatic optic neurop-
of the force to the intracanalicular segment of the athy along with fractures of sphenoid wing and
optic nerve. anterior clinoid process with displacement, lateral
decompression via pterional approach should be
Contusion of intracanalicular portion of optic considered.
nerve produces localized optic nerve ischemia
and edema. The edematous ischemic axons result Procedure:
in further neural compression within the fixed
diameter optic canal predisposing to the develop- The instruments used in endoscopic sinus surgery
ment of intracanalicular compartment syndrome. are used in this surgery also. In addition through
The basis of optic nerve decompression is enlarg- cut dissecting instruments and powered instru-
ing this bottle neck area of optic foramen in order ments are also used. A 4 mm fine diamond burr is
to prevent ischemia caused due to nerve swelling. commonly used. When using powered
drill adequate irrigation should be ensured in
Endoscopic optic nerve decompression contro- order to avoid thermal damage to the nerve
versies: during drilling process. The entire procedure is
Nerve decompression should be performed performed ideally under general anesthesia with
only for indirect traumatic optic neuritis. Direct the patient supine and head elevated.
traumatic optic neuritis is an irreversible injury. The nasal cavity is packed with 4 % xylocaine
Studies reveal that there is a close association with 1 in 100,000 units adrenaline. This decon-
between initial visual acuity and final results after gests the nose and shrinks the turbinate thereby
the procedure. Patients who are blind and have increasing the working space for the surgeon.
extremely poor light perception when exam- It also reduces mucosal bleed during the entire
ined first are poor candidates for the procedure. process.
Fractures involving the optic canal as well as a
fragment impinging on the nerve carry worse
After removal of posterior portion of lamina Image showing sphenoid ostium exposed
papyracea, the periorbita is followed posteriorly
where it could be seen converging at the orbit-
al apex. The thick bone between the posterior
ethmoid and the sphenoid is known as the optic
tubercle.
236
This thinned out bone is removed using a Freer
elevator. This exposes the optic nerve sheath. The
optic nerve sheath is incised along the optic nerve
and through the annulus of zinn. The incision
is placed at the superomedial quadrant, as the
ophthalmic artery is located in the inferomedial
quadrant of the optic canal.
Fractures involving nasal bones if not properly 1. Nasal bones and underlying cartilage are sus-
238
ceptible for fracture because of their more promi- 6. Nasal bones undergo fracture in its lower por-
nent and central position in the face. tion and seldom the upper portion is involved in
2. These structures are also pretty brittle and the fracture line. This is because the upper por-
poorly withstands force of impact. tions of the nasal bone is supported by its articu-
3. The ease with which the nose is broken may lation with the frontal bone and frontal process of
help protect the integrity of the neck, eyes, and maxilla.
brain. Thus it acts as a protective mechanism. 7. Because of the close association between nasal
4. Nasal fractures occur in one of two main pat- bone and the cartilaginous portions of the nose,
terns- from a lateral impact or from a head-on and the nasal septum it is quite unusual for pure
impact. In lateral trauma, the nose is displaced nasal bone fractures to occur without affecting
away from the midline on the side of the injury, these structures. If closed reduction alone is
in head-on trauma, the nasal bones are pushed performed to reduce nasal bone fractures without
up and splayed so that the upper nose (bridge) correction of nasal septal fractures, this could
appears broad, but the height of the nose is col- cause progressive nasal obstruction due to uncor-
lapsed (saddle-nose deformity). In both cases, the rected deviation of nasal septum. This is because
septum is often fractured and displaced. of the tendency of the nasal septum to heal by
5. The nasal bone is composed of two parts: A fibrosis which causes bizarre deviations like “C”
thick superior portion and a thin inferior portion. “S” etc.
The intercanthal line demarcates these two por-
tions. Fractures commonly occur below this line. Since nose is the most prominent portion of the
face, its supporting bony structures have low
breaking strength the naso ethmoidal complex
fractures when exposed to forces of about 80
grams. This fact was demonstrated by Swearinger
in 1965.
240
moid is invariably involved in these fractures, and
is characteristically C shaped (Jarjaway fracture of
nasal septum).
Clinical examination:
Radiology:
Image showing fracture nasal bone as seen in
X-ray of nasal bone has very minimal role in the x-ray nasal bones
diagnosis of fractures involving the nasal bones.
CT scan of nose and sinuses helps in identifying
fractures involving other facial bones and in Le-
fort II and Lefort III fractures. Ultrasound using
10 MHz probe gives a clear view of the nasal bone
area thereby facilitating easy identification of
fractures. It also has the advantage of nil radiation
hazard to the patient. Many images can be tak-
en without any problem. It is also cost effective.
According to Lee the accuracy of ultrasound in
identifying fracture nasal bone was close to 100%
while for conventional radiographs it was close to
70%.
242
Management:
Indications for closed reduction according to
If fractures of nasal bones are left uncorrected it Bailey:
could lead to loss of structural integrity and the
soft tissue changes that follow may lead to both 1. Unilateral / Bilateral fracture of nasal bones
unfavourable appearance and function. The man- 2. Fracture of nasal septal complex with nasal de-
agement of nasal fractures is based solely on the viation of less than half of the width of the nasal
clinical assessment of function and appearance; bridge.
therefore, a thorough physical examination of a
decongested nose is paramount. Closed reduction can be performed under local /
general anaesthesia. This decision should be made
Patients with fractures involving nose will have by the surgeon taking the patient into confidence.
intense bleeding from nose making assessment a There is no difference in the results produced
little difficult. Bleeding must first be controlled by between surgeries performed under local anaes-
nasal packing. These patients also have consid- thesia and general anaesthesia.
erable amount of swelling involving the dorsum
of the nose, making assessment difficult. These . Patients seem to tolerate fracture reduction un-
patients must be conservatively managed for at der local anaesthesia
least 3 weeks for the oedema to subside to enable .
precise assessment of bony injury. According to Preoperative profile photograph of the patient is a
Cummins Fracture reduction should be accom- must. This will give a general idea about adequacy
plished when accurate evaluation and manipula- of reduction.
tion of the mobile nasal bones can be performed;
this is usually within 5-10 days in adults and 3-7 Local anaesthesia:
days in children. Reduction is ideally performed
immediately after injury before oedema sets in. This requires a thorough understanding of inner-
If oedema has already set in it is prudent to wait vation of nose.
for it to subside because it is difficult to ascertain
adequacy of reduction in the presence of oedema. Innervation of nose:
Both topical and infiltrative anaesthesia is used 2% xylocaine is infiltrated in the following areas:
for reduction of nasal bones.n4% xylocaine topi- 1. Through the intercartilagenous area over the
cal is used to pack the nasal cavity. 4% xylocaine nasal bones
mixed with 1 in 100000 adrenaline is used to 2. Over the canine fossa
pack the nasal cavity. This not only anesthetizes
the nasal cavity mucosa but also causes shrinking Most of class I fractures can be reduced by closed
of the turbinates making instrumentation easier. reduction and immobilization using Plaster of
Both nasal cavities are packed. The amount of Paris cast. In majority of cases digital pressure
4% xylocaine used should not exceed 4 ml as the alone is sufficient for the job.
toxic dose is about 7 ml of 4% xylocaine. It must
be borne in mind that 2% xylocaine is also going
to be used as infiltration anaesthesia. One cotton
pledget soaked in 4% xylocaine is inserted just
under the upper lip and held in position for a
couple of minutes.
244
of the nasal bones and septum
2. Deviation of nasal pyramid of more than half
of the width of the nasal bridge.
3. Fracture dislocation of caudal septum
4. Open fractures involving the nasal septum
5. Persistent nasal deformity even after meticu-
lous closed reduction
Open reduction:
246
contour. This is because the facial contour is di- bones and their attachments to one another. The
rectly influenced by underlying bony architecture. central midface contains many fragile bones that
could easily crumble when subjected to strong
1. Fracture and dislocation of this bone not only forces. These fragile bones
causes cosmetic defects but also disrupts ocular are surrounded by thicker bones of the facial but-
and mandibular functions too. The zygomatic re- tress system lending it some strength and stability.
gion is a prominent portion of the face next only
to the dorsum of the nose. This predisposes this Components of Buttress system:
bone to various trauma.
For better understanding the components of the
2. The bony architecture of this bone is rather facial buttress system have been divided into:
unique, it enables it to withstand blows with
significant impact without being fractured. At the 1. Vertical buttresses
most it gets disarticulated along its suture lines. 2. Horizontal buttresses
Fractures can involve any of the four articulations
of zygoma which include zygomatico-maxillary Vertical buttress:
complex, zygomatic complex proper, orbitozy-
gomatic complex. Fractures involving zygoma These buttresses are very well developed.
should be repaired at the earliest because it can They include:
cause both functional and cosmetic defects. Im-
portant functional defects involving this bone is 1. Nasomaxillary
restriction of mouth opening due to impingement 2. Zygomaticomaxillay
on the coronoid process. 3. Pterygomaxillay
4. Vertical mandible
3. It is hence mandatory to diagnose and treat this Majority of the forces absorbed by midface are
condition properly. It is also important to reduce masticatory in nature. Hence the vertical buttress-
this fracture and fix it accurately, because skele- es are well developed in humans.
tal healing after inadequate reduction can cause
reduced projection of malar region of the face Horizontal buttresses:
leading on to cosmetic deformities. Accurate as-
sessment of position of the fractured bone should These buttresses interconnect and provide sup-
be performed in relation to skull base posteriorly port for the vertical buttresses.
and midface anteriorly. This assessment is very They include:
important before reduction is attempted to ensure 1. Frontal bar
accurate reduction of the fractured fragments. 2. Infraorbital rim & nasal bones
3. Hard palate & maxillary alveolus
Importance of facial buttresses in fracture of mid-
dle third of face:
Group I fractures:
Group II fractures:
This group includes isolated fractures of the arch
of zygoma. These patients present with
trismus and cosmetic deformities.
248
and followed by the action of masseter the frac- mouth. Repair of fractures involving this area
tured fragment may distract making the cosmetic should be carried out through multiple approach-
deformity well noticeable. es which include:
1. Severe comminution
2. Displacement of orbital rim
3. Displacement of greater than 50% of the orbital
floor with prolapse of orbital contents into the
maxillary sinus
4. Orbital floor fracture of greater than 2 cm2
5. Combination of inferior and medial orbital
wall fractures
6. Suspected involvement of orbital apex
Our patients commonly presented with cosmetic
defect of the malar area, followed by trismus.
250
following injury. Fractures involving zygomatic
arch can cause inability of movement of mandi-
ble. These fractures can be reduced using Gillie’s
temporal approach or Dingman’s supraorbital ap-
proach. Other approaches include Buccal sulcus
approach.
Ruler test:
252
Image showing fracture arch of zygoma being
reduced
Image showing two point fixation
Zygomatic complex fractures:
Type B fracture:
This type of fracture involves all 3 buttresses. Also
known as Tripod fracture. This fracture will have
to be treated by two point fixation / three point
fixation techniques.
Type C fracture:
These are comminuted fractures involving zygo-
ma.
Orbital floor is the weakest component of the zy-
Image showing three point fixation gomatic-maxillary complex. Type A3, B and C are
associated with fracture of the floor of orbit with
As shown in the figure three point fixation risk of injury to orbital contents.
includes fixing:
1. Frontozygomatic suture
2. Infraorbital rim
3. Zygomatico maxillary buttress
1. Type A
2. Type B
3. Type C
Type A :
This type is associated with one component of the
254
Blow out Fracture
Introduction:
Blow out fracture of orbit was first described by The thin anterior limb blends with the orbicularis
Lang in early 1900’s. The exact description of the oculi muscle and the periosteum of lateral orbital
fracture and the terminology (blow out fracture) rim. The thicker posterior limb gets attached to
was first coined by Converse and Smith. It was the Whitnall’s tubercle of the zygoma. The medial
infact Smith who first described inferior rectus canthal tendon is intimately related to the lacri-
entrapment in between the fractured fragments, mal system.
causing decreased ocular mobility.
The upper and the lower puncta begin 5 – 7 mm
Anatomy of orbit: lateral to the medial canthus and continue as
common cannaliculus into the lacrimal sac lo-
A brief discussion of anatomy of orbit will not be cated between the anterior and posterior limbs of
out of place here. Bony orbital cavity is formed by medial canthal tendon within the lacrimal fossa.
contributions from:
The lacrimal sac empties its contents into the in-
1. Lacrimal bone ferior meatus through the nasolacrimal duct. The
2. Orbital process of maxilla lacrimal gland is located in the lateral portion of
3. Orbital process of zygoma the upper lid. It is divided into a larger orbital and
4. Orbital process of frontal bone smaller palpebral portion by the lateral horn of
5. Ethmoid bones levator aponeurosis. Anteriorly the gland’s orbital
Theories accounting for blow out fracture: The So according to this theory for blow out fracture
exact mechanism causing blow out fracture is yet to occur the eye ball should sustain direct blow
to be elucidated. Two theories have been going pushing it into the orbit. Water House in 1999 did
around for quite sometime. They are: a detailed study of these two mechanisms by ap-
1. Buckling theory plying force to the cadaveric orbit. He infact used
2. Hydraulic theory fresh unfixed cadavers for the investigation.
256
He described two types of fractures: A complete ophthalmic examination is a must in
all these patients.
Type I: A small fracture confined to the floor of
the orbit (actually mid medial floor) with her- Indications for surgical repair:
niation of orbital contents in to the maxillary 1. Persistent diplopia in the primary position of
sinus. This fracture was produced when force was gaze
applied directly to the globe (Hydraulic theory). 2. Symptomatic disturbance of ocular mobility –
if persisting for more than 2
Type II: A large fracture involving the floor and weeks is considered to be an absolute indication
medial wall with herniation of orbital contents. by many. This two week window is considered
This type of fracture was caused by force applied because it is the time taken by edema / hemato-
to the orbital rim ma of orbit to resolve. Two weeks after the injury
(Buckling theory). fibrosis and adhesions begin to
develop. Any surgery performed before develop-
Clinical features of blow out fracture: ment of adhesions / fibrosis has best results.
3. Radiological evidence of extraocular muscle
. Intraocular pain entrapment
. Numbness of certain regions of face 4. Enophthalmos of more than 2 mm
. Diplopia 5. Large fractures involving the floor of the orbit
. Inability to move the eye (more than 50% of the floor is involved)
. Blindness 6. Infraorbital nerve hypoaesthesia / anesthesia
. Epistaxis 7. Presence of oculo cardiac reflex (common in
trap door type of fracture).
Patient may also show signs of:
Surgical repair should be performed immediately
. Enophthalmos – This can be measured objec- in these patients.
tively by Hess charts and Binocular single vision.
. Oedema Surgical repair should be delayed:
. Haematoma 1. When there is presence of hyphema
. Globe displacement 2. Ocular rupture
. Restricted ocular mobility 3. Extensive oedema
. Infraorbital anesthesia
Causes of ocular motility disturbances:
Proptosis in these patients is sinister because it
indicates retrobulbar / peribubar hemorrhage. 1. Intraorbital tissue hemorrhage – usually re-
Pupillary dysfunction associated with visual solves during the first week of injury
disturbances indicates injury to optic nerve and 2. Intraorbital tissue oedema – resolves during the
it is an emergency. Patient must be taken up for second week of injury
immediate optic nerve 3. Entrapment of extraocular muscles
decompression to save vision. 4. Entrapment of orbital fat
5. Direct damage to extraocular muscles – causes
258
comminution from the laminar bar to the lateral graphs, hence CT scan is diagnostic.
orbital wall.
Imaging:
1. Periorbital oedema
2. Ecchymosis
3. Subcutaneous emphysema due to escape of air
from ethmoid sinus in the periorbital space
4. Epistaxis
5. Enophthalmos – According to Pearl enophthal-
mos is worse in medial blow out fractures than
fractures involving other walls of orbit.
Image showing classic tear drop sign in xray Classification of medial wall of orbit:
paranasal sinuses Type I – Pure medial wall of orbit fracture
Type II – Medial wall and floor of orbit fracture
CT scan is diagnostic. Type III – Fractures involving medial wall, floor
Blow out fracture involving the medial wall of of orbit and trimalar fracture
orbit: Type IV – Fractures involving medial wall, floor
Fractures involving medial wall of orbit may of orbit, maxillary, naso orbital, and frontal bones
occur alone or as part of more complex orbital
fractures. Pure medial wall fractures are really
rare. Fractures involving
medial orbital wall may be missed in plain radio-
260
to decide the optimal management modality. A
These classification systems are based on CT scan brief review of anatomy of lateral orbital wall
findings. wont be out of place here. The lateral orbital wall
is formed by the zygomatic bone anteriorly. This
Type I medial orbital wall fractures are commonly bone is responsible for mid face prominence. The
caused by assault, while other types of fractures posterior wing of sphenoid forms the posteri-
are caused by road traffic accidents. or portion of the lateral orbital wall along with
the anterior corner of the middle cranial fossa.
Visual disturbances were commonly seen in type Fractures involving the greater wing of sphenoid
I, II, and III fractures involving the medial wall of is very rare.
orbit, and is very rare in type IV fractures.
Articulation between the zygomatic bone and
Eye ball injuries are common in type II fractures greater wing of sphenoid is very broad and is the
of medial wall. Diplopia and enophthalmos are commonest site in fractures involving lateral or-
commonly seen in type II fractures. bital wall. Fractures involving lateral wall of orbit
is also associated with disruption of zygomatic
Displacement of orbital walls and herniation of bone articulations with frontal, temporal and
soft tissues were quite high for type I, type II and maxillary bones.
type IV injuries. It is very uncommon in type III
injuries, suggesting that when there is associated Clinical features:
malar fracture then the fragments are more linear
without any displacement. 1. These patients have varying degrees of mid face
deformities
Type I fractures can be repaired using fronto 2. Displacement of lateral orbital wall has a dra-
ethmoidal lesion / Lynch Howarth and reduction matic effect on the position of the eye. The lateral
of prolapsed orbital contents and supporting the orbital rim is approximately at the equator of the
wall using Marlex mesh, whereas other types of globe.
fractures involving medial orbital wall can be re- Infro lateral displacement of the lateral orbital
paired by subciliary / transconjuctival approach- wall will have significant change in the position of
es. the orbit when compared to that of simple infra-
orbital floor blowout fracture.
Fractures involving lateral orbital wall: 3. Visual loss may occur due to injury to the optic
nerve. Whenever there is visual loss then retro-
Fractures of lateral orbital wall is always associat- bulbar hemorrhage, penetrating foreign body
ed with fractures of zygoma and malar complex- or bony fragment impinging on the optic nerve
es. This fracture is common in adults and is very should be considered.
rare in children. 4. Lateral canthal dystopia
This fracture should be suspected in all patients 5. Ecchymosis
who have severe facial injury. 6. Subconjunctival hemorrhage
Imaging is a must not only for diagnosis but also Axial and coronal CT scans should be taken in all
Before surgery a forced duction test should al- 1. Approaches to lateral wall and orbital roof
ways be performed to rule out intraocular muscle 2. Approaches to medial wall of orbit
entrapment. 3. Approaches to the floor of the orbit
Lateral upper eyelid crease incision can be used to
expose zygomaticofrontal suture line. Infraorbital
rim can be exposed via transconjuctival / subcili-
262
Approaches to lateral wall and orbital roof in- Upper blepharoplasty:
clude:
a. Lateral brow incision First the supratarsal fold is marked. It is typically
b. Upper blepharoplasty incision 8-9 mm above the ciliary line. Xylocaine with
c. Coronal incision adrenaline is injected subcutaneously, down to
the lateral orbital rim at the zygomaticofrontal
Lateral brow incision: Is suited for exposing fron- suture. Skin is incised, and the underlying orbicu-
tal and zygomatico sphenoid sutures. The lateral laris oculi muscle should be divided parallel to its
portion of the superior orbital rim is also exposed fibers. This is ideally done using scissors. Dissec-
well by this incision. The brow incision is placed tion is then performed in a plane superficial to
just below the hair follicles of lateral 2-3 cm of the the orbital septum and lacrimal gland, until the
upper eyebrow. lateral orbital rim and zygomaticofrontal suture
as needed. The advantage of this approach is the
cosmetically acceptable scar.
Coronal approach:
264
eyelash line. This incision is usually performed
using a 15 blade. Medially this incision should
fall short of the punctum, while laterally it can be
extended even up to 15 mm beyond the lateral
canthus. The lateral extension of this incision is
preferred should be extended horizontally and
not inferiorly in order to promote formation of
aesthetically acceptable scar.
In subtarsal variation of this procedure the inci- Transconjunctival approach to orbit: This meth-
sion is sited in the subtarsal fold about 5-7 mm od was popularized by Tessier. Converse etal
below the eyelash line. After repair a Frost suture reported treating a series of patients with blow
is applied to support the lower eyelid. out fracture involving the floor of the orbit using
this incision. This is the most preferred approach
Advantages of this approach: for orbital surgeries because of low complication
rates and excellent cosmesis. In this method the
1. Easy to perform lower eye lid is pulled forward. To increase the
2. Gives broad access to the floor of orbit laxity a lateral canthotomy should be performed.
Image showing canthotomy being performed In cases of blow out fractures involving the
medial portion of the floor of the orbit Cald-
Two methods can be performed via this incision. wel luc procedure can be performed to reduce
the fracture fragment. Nasal endoscope can be
1. Preseptal method and introduced through the caldwel luc fenestra to
improve visualisation.
2. Retroseptal method.
The prolapsed orbital contents are freed and
Preseptal method: In this method incision is reduced. Fractured fragments repositioned if
made at the edge of the tarsal plate to create a possible and stabilized using plate and screws. If
space in front of the orbital plate to reach the defect is large prosthesis can be utilized to stabi-
orbital rim. The floor of the lize the orbital floor.
orbit is reached by dissecting the Muller’s muscle
and the eyelid fascia. Dissection then proceeds
between orbital septum and orbicularis oculi
muscle. The periosteum lining the infraorbital
rim should be excised and dissected to expose
completely the floor and lateral wall of the orbit if
necessary.
266
caused by scarring that occurs in this area due to
Complications of transconjunctival approach to excessive tissue damage. Unipolar cautery when
orbital floor: used to make conjunctival incision should be
used in the lowest possible setting. Laceration and
1. Eye lid avulsion conjunctival tears should be avoided.
2. Button holing of lower eyelid
3. Canthal dehiscence While performing lateral canthotomy lysis of the
4. Cicatricial ectropion superior crus of lateral canthus should be avoid-
5. Entropion ed. Only the inferior crus should be lysed. More-
6. Lower eyelid retraction over while performing lateral canthotomy exces-
7. Scleral show sive incisions of conjunctiva should be avoided.
8. Hematoma
9. Prolonged chemosis It has been shown proper canthotomy avoids
10. Lacrimal sac laceration excessive traction of lower eyelid during surgery,
thus prevents lid lacerations.
Factors that can cause problems with transcon-
junctival approach:
1. Placing plastic corneal shield Image showing lateral canthus exposed before
2. Use of Jaeger retractor which protects the cor- canthotomy
nea while retracting the orbit Placement of inci-
sion – This is also vital in avoiding complications.
268
Technical aspects of conjunctival closure:
Image showing orbital floor being exposed This is another important step in transconjuctival
procedures where lateral canthotomy has been
resorted to. If not performed properly canthal
migration has been known to occur in the inferi-
or direction. It is always better to use permanent
suture materials like Teflon impregnated braided
polyester suture material to suspend the inferi-
or canthal tendon. In case extensive dissection
was performed to expose the lateral wall of orbit
by stripping orbital periosteum in that area, the
inferior canthal tendon should be secured to
the lateral bony wall of orbit by using 30 gauge
wire. This will prevent canthal migration in these
patients. If both superior and inferior crura of
lateral canthal tendon were excised during sur-
gery then reconstruction gets a bit complicated.
Image showing fracture floor of orbit exposed In these patients the inferior crus must be reat-
tached to the lateral orbital wall just posterior and
superior to Whitnall’s tubercle. This is usually
done by using 30 gauge wires. Then only should
the superior crura should be reattached.
Frost stitch:
Endoscopic reduction / repair of blow out frac-
This stitch is usually used to splint the lower ture:
eyelid during the period of repair. This is usual-
ly a must in patients with excessive chemosis / Indications:
proptosis. This stitch is usually placed through
the lower eyelid and suspended from the fore- They are more or less identical to that of tradi-
head with the help of a tape at least for a period tional repair procedures. Indications include:
of three days following surgery. This provides 1. Isolated fractures involving the floor of the
excellent splinting to the lower eye lid during this orbit with extraocular muscle entrapment.
crucial phase of healing. 2. Preoperative Enophthalmos
3. More than 50% disruption of orbital floor
4. Trap door and medial blow out fractures of
floor of orbit respond the best to Endoscopic
repair.
In lateral blow out fractures of orbital floor En-
doscopic repair will jeopardize the Infraorbital
nerve as extensive dissection is necessary in that
area.
270
Procedure: injure dental roots, Infraorbital nerve and the
nasal aperture. As an alternative a bone saw can
Primary surgeon if he is right handed should be used to remove a 1 x 2 cms plate of bone from
stand to the right of the patient. The table is usu- the canine fossa area and can always be plated
ally turned 180 degrees from anesthesia equip- back in position after surgery is over. This proce-
ment. The assistant surgeon and the nurse should dure is considered more anatomical as the area of
be on the left side of the patient. Monitor should surgery is reconstructed.
be placed at the head end of the patient. Both the
surgeon and his assistant should have an unob- A retractor is used to retract the upper lip. Ideally
structed view of the monitor. a Greenberg retractor is best suited for the pro-
cedure because of its self retaining nature. If not
Incision: available a Langhan’s retractor can also be used.
Caution should be exercised while retracting the
The upper buccal sulcus on the side of injury is upper lip in not causing excessive traction to the
infiltrated with 2% xylocaine mixed with 1 in Infraorbital nerve.
100,000 units adrenaline. This infiltration helps
in elevation of soft tissue and periosteum from A 30 degree endoscope is introduced through the
the anterior portion of the maxilla. It also has antrostomy with the angulation facing upwards.
the added advantage of minimizing bleeding. A The entire floor of the orbit can be studied. If nec-
4 cm sub labial Caldwell incision is given in that essary the maxillary sinus can be irrigated with
area exposing the anterior wall of the maxilla. saline via the irrigation sheath of the endoscope
Dissection is performed in a subperiosteal plane and sucked out clearing blood clots and other de-
up to the level of Infraorbital foramen. Excessive bris from the maxillary sinus cavity. This step will
traction should not be exerted in the Infraorbital help in better visualization of the area of interest.
nerve area. The natural ostium of maxillary sinus can be
located in the postero superior portion of
A 4 mm antrostomy is performed over the ca- the medial wall of the sinus. The infra orbital
nine fossa are. This is the thinnest portion of the nerve could be seen as a while line running from
anterior wall of the maxilla. Boundaries of canine the orbital apex to the Infraorbital foramen. It is
fossa include: imperative on the part of the surgeon to identify
the maxillary sinus ostium and infra orbital nerve
1. Canine eminence medially before proceeding further, in order to avoid inju-
2. Maxillary tuberosity laterally ry to these structures.
3. Infraorbital foramen superiorly
4. Superior alveolar margin inferiorly Pulse test: This test is usually performed after
completely visualizing the floor of orbit as well
The antrostomy is widened using kerrison’s as the above mentioned vital intra sinus struc-
rounger. Final dimensions of antrostomy should tures. This test is performed while the floor of the
at least be 1 x 2cms and should lie about 2mm orbit is fully under Endoscopic view. Pressure is
below the Infraorbital foramen. When enlarging applied to eye ball causing mild displacement of
the antrostomy care must be taken not to the fractured floor of orbit. This can be visual-
Endoscopic repair of trap door fracture: Endoscopic repair of medial blow out fracture:
In trap door fracture of orbital floor there is These fractures pose real challenges during En-
mild – moderate degree of orbital fat herniation. doscopic reduction. These fractures are usually
Strangulation of herniated orbital contents are comminuted and unstable, hence requires more
common in these patients. This area appears dissection and an implant for reconstruction of
endoscopically as enlarged and tense area. These orbital floor. About 5 – 7mm of maxillary sinus
fractures can be managed by reduction and re- mucosa should be dissected around the fracture
positioning of the fractured and displaced frag- taking care to protect the maxillary sinus osti-
ments. No prosthesis is necessary. As a first step um and the Infraorbital nerve. The entire cir-
in reduction of these fractures an angled elevator cumference of the fracture should be visualized.
is used to expose 5 – 7 mm of maxillary sinus Bleeding if any should be controlled using either
bone close to the lateral edge of the defect. Care oxymetazoline pledgets or adrenaline pledgets.
is taken not to disrupt the mucosa over the hinge
area as it would cause complete disruption of the All fractured fragments should be separated from
272
the periorbita and removed. After defining the
margins of fracture 3 – 5 mm dissection of the Postoperatively all patients should undergo CT
orbital surface of the defect is performed. This scan to ensure that no orbital fat / contents are
step releases the periorbita around the defect entrapped, and no bony fragments have been
to accommodate the implant. After this step a pushed into the orbit during placement of im-
greater degree of prolapse of orbital contents into plant.
the maxillary sinus cavity could be seen. This may
seem to be worse than the pre op condition, but is Patients with zygomatico - maxillary complex
to be expected. Silastic sheet of approximate size fractures also have orbital component injury. It
is introduced. The implant is resized and shaped should be borne in mind that there is a possibility
according to the size of the defect by trial and of orbital floor fracture worsening after reduction
error. It should be roughly 1.5 – 2 mm larger than procedures involving the zygoma component. All
the size of the defect. these patients must undergo Endoscopic exam-
ination of the orbital floor bearing in mind
Orbital contents are gently reduced using a peri- of this possibility. If there is also associated frac-
osteal elevator and the implant is inserted. The ture of orbital floor then it should be managed
implant is usually held in position by the orbital endoscopically.
rim and the posterior bony shelf. The implant
should ideally be positioned between the medial Combined Transconjunctival – Endonasal –
and lateral shelves. A pulse test should be per- Transantral approach:
formed to ensure that the implant is firmly in
place. A forced duction test should also be per- This approach is finding prominence in ophthal-
formed to rule out orbital content entrapment. mology literature. Important drawback of this
procedure is extensive removal of lateral nasal
Key points that must be borne in mind while wall to facilitate Endoscopic visualization. With
managing Medial blow out fracture endoscopical- the introduction of 70 degree endoscopes remov-
ly: al of lateral wall can be minimized.
Similarly a gentle tug to the medial rectus muscle Caution: This approach is not suitable for small
will help in identification of entrapment of medial children with tooth buds in the anterior wall of
rectus muscle within the fracture fragments (this the maxillary antrum.
is called forced duction test). If the orbital con-
tents are found to be prolapsed through the defect
in the medial wall of orbit, then it must be gently
reduced. If forced duction test is positive then
the entrapped extraocular muscle (medial rectus
in this case) should be freed under Endoscopic
vision.
274
have the following features: 2. It can migrate posteriorly towards the orbital
apex causing further complications.
1. Material should be thin, strong and light on
weight
2. It should be easily cut and shaped
3. Once molded it should retain its shape
4. It should be radio opaque facilitating further
radiological studies
1. It is very difficult to remove in cases of infec- Image showing the interior of maxillary sinus as
tion as the tissue would have grown around and viewed from canine fossa approach
through the pores of the mesh.
276
Use of Foley’s catheter in anterior wall fractures vated over the anterior wall of maxilla. Fractured
of maxillary sinus fragments seen dislodged from the anterior wall
of maxilla can be repositioned with a plate and
Introduction: screw / metal wire.
Maxilla acts as a bridge between the skull base Inferior antrostomy is performed. 16 size Foley’s
superiorly and the dental occlusal plane inferior- catheter introduced through it and is inflated with
ly. It is associated intimately with the oral cavity, air until fracture segments are aligned. Foley’s
nasal cavity and orbits. This relationship makes catheter is removed after two weeks.
the maxilla an important structure both function-
ally and cosmetically. Fracture involving these
bones could lead not only to cosmetic disfigure-
ment but can also be life-threatening. Timely
and systematic repair of these fractures provides
the best chance to correct deformity and prevent
unfavourable sequel.
Procedure:
Faciomaxillary and upper airway injuries are due The fracture extends from the nasal septum to the
to sharp or blunt injuries to the head or neck. lateral pyriform rims, travels horizontally above
Sharp injuries usually result in lacerations and the teeth apices, crosses below the zygomatico-
penetrating injuries, whereas blunt injuries result maxillary junction, and traverses the pterygomax-
in fractures to the facial skeleton. Over 50% of illary junction to interrupt the pterygoid plates.
facial trauma are the result of motor vehicle ac-
cidents. Rest are due to physical violence, sports
278
Image showing Lefort I, II and III types of fractures
280
When these are satisfied, management is directed 6) Occlusal radiograph for split palate.
towards the facial, neck and other injuries.
CT scan is preferable
GENERAL MANAGEMENT
DEFINITIVE MANAGEMENT
In patients without airway obstruction, a 30°
head-up position is preferred so as to encourage Goals of treatment –
drainage of blood, saliva and CSF away from the 1) Precise anatomical reduction to cranial base
airway. This also helps in preventing obstruction above and to the mandible below.
by the disrupted tissue. Following airway man- 2) Stable fixation of reduced fragments
agement, maxillary and mandibular fragments 3) Preservation of blood supply to fractured site.
can be repositioned and a head wrap applied to 4) Restoration of function.
maintain stabilization.
REDUCTION OF MAXILLA
The definitive approach towards Faciomaxillary
fractures can be planned after a “grace period” of 1. Manual reduction.
up to 10 days taking into account patient comfort. 2. Reduction with wires.
But in orbital injuries when ocular function is at 3. Reduction using disimpaction forceps.
risk, an early surgery is mandatory. When gross 4. Reduction by means of traction(elastics)
facial swelling occurs, definitive surgery should Closed reduction can be done in
be delayed and measures like wound debride- 1) Non displaced fracture
ment, removal of foreign bodies, closure of facial 2) Grossly comminuted fractures
lacerations, ice packs, and head-up nursing to re- 3) Fractures exposed by significant loss of overly-
duce venous pressure and encourage fluid resorp- ing soft tissues.
tion should be instituted. Prophylactic antibiotics 4) Edentulous maxillary fractures
should be used in those with CSF rhinorrhoea, 5) In children with developing dentition.
compound wounds and when operative fixation Open reduction to be done in
of fractures is performed. 1) Displaced fractures
2) Multiple fractures of facial bones
RADIOLOGICAL EVALUATION 3) Fractures of edentulous maxilla with severe
displacement.
Once the patient is fully stabilized, radiologic 4) Edentulous maxillary fracture opposing an
evaluation should commence. edentulous mandibular fracture.
When using Plain films, the following radio- 5) Delay of treatment and interposition of soft
graphs should be taken – tissues between non-contacting displaced
1) Lateral skull view fracture segments.
2) Water’s view 6) Specific systemic conditions contraindicating
3) PA & AP views of skull IMF.
4) OPG
5) Towne’s view- zygomatic arches, vertical rami
of mandible.
Nasoantral window:
282
Clinical features:
Endoscopic orbital decompression
Before attempting to manage a patient with Thy-
Introduction: roid associated orbitopathy accurate assessment
should be made regarding the disease activity,
Orbital decompression surgery has been indicat- temporal progression and its severity. Basic aim
ed in patients with compressive optic neuropathy, is to differentiate active stage of the disease from
severe corneal exposure, cosmetic deformity due the burnt-out stage. Treatment of these two
to proptosis. Traditional orbital decompression conditions are rather different. Active moderate
approaches were fraught with complications. to severe congestive orbitopathy may need active
With the advent of nasal endoscopes decom- intervention whereas mild congestive orbitopathy
pression is being carried out transnasally under needs observation. Vision threatening dysthyroid
endoscopic guidance. The entire medial wall of optic neuropathy occurs in less than 5% of pa-
orbit can be taken down transnasally using nasal tients with Graves’ disease.
endoscope, and the inferior wall of orbit can be
removed using the same approach. Currently Clinical features of optic neuropathy / impending
endoscopic orbital decompression is being per- optic neuropathy include:
formed commonly with very minimal compli-
cations. The aim of this paper is to review the 1. loss of visual acuity
current literature on the subject. 2. Disturbances in color vision
3. Visual field defects
Thyroid associated orbitopathy can cause severe 4. Afferent pupillary defect
facial disfigurement. In severe cases it could 5. Swelling involving optic disc
lead even to blindness. Surgical decompression
of orbit could very well alter facial appearance. Diagnosis can be confirmed by measuring Visual
Patients with thyroid associated orbitopathy Evoked Potentials. If it shows increase in latency
should be warned that only a marginal improve- or reduction in amplitude the diagnosis is con-
ment to facial appearance is possible. Frequent firmed. If these patients are not picked up early
surgical procedures may be needed to produce and aggressively treated 30% of them may suffer
optimal results. This procedure should never be irreversible vision loss. Risk factors for optic neu-
considered as a beautification exercise. Majority ropathy include older age, smoking and male sex.
of Thyroid associated orbitopathy patients don’t
require surgical treatment. The need for surgery Pathophysiological mechanism implicated in
increases significantly with age. Need for surgery optic nerve involvement:
triples after the age of 50. During active phase of
this disease Medical management with immuno- Compression of optic nerve / its blood supply by
suppressive measures should be the first line of the orbital contents especially by the hypertro-
management. phied intraocular muscles have been implicated.
Studies have correlated intraocular muscle size
and restriction of ocular mobility with incidence
of optic neuropathy. Proptosis does not correlate
284
2001 popularized this procedure.
Orbital decompression techniques:
Bony orbital decompression:
History:
Orbital decompression can be performed by
Earliest report of orbital decompression was removal of one or more walls of the orbit. Graded
published by Dollinger in 1911. In 1931 Naffziger orbital decompression is always preferred de-
popularized transfrontal orbital roof decompres- pending on the degree of proptosis. This concept
sion. The advantage of this approach was that was first suggested by Kikkawa et al. Three wall
it allowed access to orbital apices of both sides decompression provides the best proptosis re-
and hence was very useful in managing bilateral duction with acceptable esthetic appeal. During
disorders. The flip side was that proptosis reduc- 1980’s two wall decompression involving medial
tion was not impressive. This procedure was also and inferomedial walls of orbit was practiced.
time-consuming needing assistance from neu- This procedure had a high incidence of post-op-
rosurgeon on the table. Communication of orbit erative diplopia due to inferior displacement of
with cranial contents lead to the development of globe. This can easily be avoided by preserving
pulsating proptosis. Sewall (1936) used medial the inferomedial strut between ethmoid and max-
approach to decompress orbit. In this approach illary sinuses. Goldberg 16 et al.
the entire medial wall of orbit was taken down
after performing a complete ethmoidectomy. If Demonstrated that deep lateral wall decompres-
needed it can be extended up to the sphenoid si- sion alone caused 4.5 mm reduction in proptosis.
nus also allowing orbital contents to prolapse me- He used the term extended lateral orbital decom-
dially into the nasal cavity. Hirsch in 1950 used pression to include three key areas: Lacrimal
the technique described by Lewkowitz to perform keyhole – area around lacrimal gland fossa Basin
inferior orbitotomy by removing the floor of the of the infraorbital fissure – the portion of zygo-
orbit through Caldwell – Luc approach. Walsh matic bone and lateral maxilla around infraorbital
and Ogura in 1957 13 used Caldwell – Luc trans fissure.
antral approach to decompress both inferior and
medial orbital walls. Sphenoid door jam – Thick trigone of greater
wing of sphenoid which borders infratemporal
Orbital contents were allowed to prolapse into fossa laterally and middle cranial fossa posteri-
maxillary antrum and nasal cavity. This approach orly. This area makes the largest volume of bone
had the advantage of doing away with skin inci- contribution to orbit. Removal of bone from this
sions in the face. This approach too had its own area reduces proptosis by 6 mm.
flip side i.e. postoperative diplopia and infraor-
bital nerve hypesthesia. With the popular use of
nasal endoscope, the entire nasal cavity could be
accessed easily under endoscopic vision. Kennedy
et al. 15 In 1990 performed endoscopic decom-
pression of orbit by removing the medial wall of
the orbit under endoscopic vision. Michel et al. In
Endoscopic Medial wall decompression: wide middle meatal antrostomy is performed. The
floor of the orbit and the posterior wall of maxilla
This procedure is still under evaluation. Since the should be clearly visible through the antrostomy.
approach is trans nasal, facial incision is avoided. A wide antrostomy won’t get blocked even after
The medial wall of orbit is rather thin in this area. the prolapsing orbital content fills the nasal cavity
After exenteration of ethmoidal air cells this wall and maxillary sinus.
can easily be taken down allowing the orbital Infraorbital nerve should be visualized using a
contents to prolapse into the nasal cavity. This 45° endoscope because this represents the lateral
procedure can be performed either under LA or limit of bone resection. Frontal recess area should
GA. The nasal cavity is decongested. Complete be cleared adequately. Trans ethmoidal sphenoi-
uncinectomy and ethmoidectomy is performed. A dotomy should also be performed. Anterior limit
286
of resection corresponds to nasolacrimal duct, inferior wall is taken down it could cause hypo-
while superior limit corresponds to the floor of globus (inferior displacement of orbit).
anterior cranial fossa marked by the presence of
ethmoidal arteries. Fat removal orbital decompression:
Inferiorly resection should stop at the level of in- This procedure was first reported by Olivari in
sertion of inferior turbinate. Author invariably re- 1988. This procedure was considered to be rela-
moves middle turbinate to create more space for tively safe when compared to bony decompres-
the prolapsing orbital contents. Lamina papyracea sion according to him. Removal of 6ml of fat on
should be completely skeletonized and removed an average contributed to satisfactory results. It
using periosteal elevator. Lamina is removed care- has been estimated that normal average orbital fat
fully without traumatizing periorbita. It should volume is about 8ml. This could increase to 10 ml
completely be removed till the posterior ethmoid, in patients with thyroid associated orbitopathy.
close to the optic nerve where the bone is thicker. This procedure is suited for patients who have a
Only after fully exposing the periorbita should it volumetric increase in orbital fat deposition caus-
be incised to allow fat to prolapse into the nasal ing proptosis. Patient selection should be careful-
cavity and maxillary sinus cavity. Endoscopic ly made after performing MRI imaging of orbit.
decompression could achieve proptosis reduc- Infero medial removal of orbital fat could be a
tion between 3 – 5 mm. Greater reduction can be worthwhile option of treating proptosis as this
achieved if combined with lateral orbitotomy. It area is devoid of crucial anatomical structures.
is very important to retain lamina papyracea in
the region of frontal recess to prevent obstruction Lateral orbitotomy (lateral wall decompression):
due to prolapsing orbital fat.
This approach is credited with the maximum
Complications of this procedure include: reduction of exopthalmos. Indications for this
procedure include:
1. Diplopia
2. Sinusitis 1. Esthetic rehabilitation for exphthalmos
3. Frontal & maxillary sinus mucocele 2. Retrobulbar pressure
4. CSF leak 3. Exposure keratopathy / Lagopthalmos
4. Dysthyroid optic neuropathy
Walsh – Ogura decompression: Traditionally this
procedure has been performed to manage Graves Procedure:
ophthalmopathy. This surgery is performed via This surgery is ideally performed under general
trans antral Caldwell Luc approach. Two walls of anesthesia. Skin incision begins at the lateral third
orbit are removed i.e. medial and inferior walls. of upper eyelid crease. It follows a sigmoid course
Medial wall removal is difficult in this procedure over the zygomatic bone. Orbital rim is exposed
as it is difficult to visualize lamina papyracea tran- by blunt
santrally, hence it is virtually impossible to com- dissection. Temporalis muscle in this area should
pletely decompress medial wall of orbit 18. This also be removed till the periosteum becomes
procedure is entirely not risk free. If too much visible.
1. Diplopia
2. Loss of vision due to bleeding and increase in
intraocular tension
3. Temporary numbness over zygomatico tempo-
ral supply area of trigeminal nerve
4. Mild oscillopsia during chewing
288
Image showing prolapse of orbital fat inside the
nasal cavity after lamina papyracea is removed
290
Several avenues were tried during the early 20th approach. The advent of nasal endoscopes has re-
century to manage patients with dacryocystitis. vived interest again in the intranasal approach. In
One such procedure was an attempt to drain addition to avoiding scar formation endoscopes
the lacrimal sac into the maxillary sinus. Many provide excellent visualization.
intranasal approaches were described during this
period, some of them advocating opening up or How we have reached a stage where all DCR’s are
resection of the lower aspect of the nasolacri- being performed with nasal endoscope by the
mal canal as well as use of glass tubes or wire to ENT surgeon. It should be stressed that 90% of
keep the new passageway patent. It was West and lacrimal pathways belong to the nasal cavity and
Polyak who popularized these procedures with it is more appropriate for an ENT surgeon to be
reasonable success. involved in the management of dacryocystitis.
292
Image showing osteology of orbit and face
The maxillary line is an important landmark for The maxillary line is an important landmark for
endoscopic DCR. It is easily identified as a cur- endoscopic DCR. It is easily identified as a cur-
vilinear eminence along the lateral nasal wall, vilinear eminence along the lateral nasal wall,
which runs from the anterior attachment of the which runs from the anterior attachment of the
middle turbinate to the root of the inferior turbi- middle turbinate to the root of the inferior turbi-
nate. Its location corresponds to the suture nate. Its location corresponds to the suture
line between maxillary and lacrimal bones. Ex- line between maxillary and lacrimal bones. Ex-
posure of the posterior half of the sac typically posure of the posterior half of the sac typically
requires removal of thin uncinate process and requires removal of thin uncinate process and
underlying lacrimal bone located posterior to the underlying lacrimal bone located posterior to the
maxillary line. Exposure of anterior sac neces- maxillary line. Exposure of anterior sac neces-
sitates removal of thicker bone in front of the sitates removal of thicker bone in front of the
maxillary line. maxillary line.
The lacrimal fossa is approximately 16 mm high, The medial orbital wall is formed anterior to
4-9 mm wide, and 2 mm deep. This fossa is slight- posterior, by the frontal process of maxilla, the
ly narrower in women. The fossa is widest at its lacrimal bone, the ethmoid bone, and the lesser
base, where it is confluent with the opening of the wing of the sphenoid bone. The thinnest portion
294
Image showing anatomy of lacrimal sac
A vertical suture runs centrally between the At the junction of the medial and inferior orbital
anterior and posterior lacrimal crests, represent- rims, at the base of the anterior lacrimal crest, a
ing the anastomosis of the maxillary bone to the small lacrimal tubercle may be palpated external-
lacrimal bone. A suture located more posteriorly ly to guide the surgeon to the lacrimal sac located
within the lacrimal fossa would indicate predom- posterior and superior to it. In nearly a third of
inance of maxillary bone, whereas a more anteri- orbits this tubercle may project posteriorly as an
orly placed suture would indicate predominance anterior lacrimal spur.
of the lacrimal bone. The nasolacrimal canal originates at the base of
296
Note the ostium of the maxillary sinus lie approximately in a vertical line to the Ante-
rior ethmoidal foramen.
the lacrimal sac and is formed by the maxillary tion due to irritation of cornea / conjunctiva (FB,
bone laterally and the lacrimal and inferior tur- trigeminal nerve stimulation).
binate bones medially. The width of the superior
portion of the canal measures on an average 4-6 Epiphora:
mm. The duct courses posteriorly and laterally in
the bone shared by the medial wall of the maxil- Usually occurs due to poor lacrimal drainage
lary sinus and the lateral nasal wall for 12 mm which could be due to:
to drain into the inferior meatus of the nasal 1. Mechanical obstruction of lacrimal drainage
cavity. system related to trauma, dacryocystolithiasis,
sinusitis and congenital nasolacrimal duct ob-
Epiphora: struction in children.
This term is used to indicate excessive tear secre- 2. Lacrimal pump failure (functional epiphora)
tion. Causes for epiphora include: may be caused by eyelid laxity (facial palsy), eye-
lid malposition and punctum eversion.
1. Hypersecretion
2. Epiphora
3. Combinations of the above
Hypersecretion:
Excessive tearing is caused by reflex hypersecre-
298
treatment modality. These tests can be classified lated next using a punctum dilator if the punctum
as: is small.
Diagnostic probing & lacrimal syringing: Image showing lower punctum being dilated
This procedure can easily and safely be performed A 24-gauge intravenous cannula is inserted into
in the OPD under local anesthesia. the inferior canaliculus, it should be aimed verti-
cally
Steps: first and then turned horizontally. The lower can-
aliculus is straightened by pulling the lower eyelid
Topical anesthesia is secured by application of downwards and laterally.
1 – 2 drops of oxybuprocaine / Benoxinate HCL
0.4% or The tip of the cannula is advanced to 3-4 mm into
4% xylocaine onto the puncta. The puncta is di- the canaliculus. A 2 ml syringe filled with distilled
300
Diagram illustrating lacrimal drainage system
imately 50% of infants at birth. If it is not patent helps to identify the cause of epiphora and also
at birth, it usually becomes patent during the first assist in surgical planning
few months of life. 3. In case of trauma to eyelid or medial face,
probing and irrigation will help to determine if
Delayed or incomplete patency is the cause of there is injury to the lacrimal drainage system.
congenital nasolacrimal duct obstruction. In In patients with acute trauma, a visible lacrimal
infants the distance from the punctum to the level probe inserted into the canaliculus or leakage
of inferior meatus is approximately 20 mm. of irrigation fluid through traumatized eyelid is
an indication for canalicular injury and must be
Indications for probing & irrigation: addressed during planned repair of trauma.
4. In patients with congenital nasolacrimal duct
1. Should be performed whenever analysis of the obstruction that does not resolve by the age of 12
lacrimal drainage system is indicated months, probing and irrigation is performed un-
2. In the case of nasolacrimal obstruction related der anesthesia to achieve patency of the system.
epiphora, this procedure provides insight into the
location and severity of obstruction if present. It
302
Dacryocystography:
Indications include:
CT:
1. Skull base reconstruction after endonasal sur- Technique of harvesting Hadad flap:
gery Nasal hairs should be trimmed. Nasal passag-
2. Reconstruction following transnasal hypophy- es should be examined and mucous if present
sectomy should be removed using suction.
3. Management of traumatic CSF leaks Nasal mucosa and turbinates are decongested
by packing with Cotton pledgets soaked in 4%
Advantages: xylocaine mixed with 1 in 100,000 adrenaline.
Care should be taken not to exceed the toxic dose
1. Well vascularized with pedicled blood supply of xylocaine which is 7 ml. The pledgets should be
(nasoseptal artery) squeezed dry before packing the nasal cavity.
2. Superior arc of rotation Using a 2 ml syringe filled with 1% xylocaine with
3. Customizable surface area which can be mod- 1:100,000 adrenaline infiltration is given in the
ified following areas:
4. Provides adequate surface area to cover the
entire anterior skull base 1. Sublabial area
5. Can be stored in the nasopharynx during the 2. Posterior portion of nasal septum
entire procedure 3. Posterior portion of middle turbinate
6. Promotes fast healing and decreases the risk of 4. Anterior face of sphenoid
CSF leak 5. Over the sphenopalatine artery
7. It is sturdy and pliable 6. Anterior portion of the septum on the side of
8. Can be taken down and reused in revision surgery
cases Using a 15 blade knife or angled Colorado tipped
304
Bovie cautery (setting at 10) posterior incisions
are given first. Post op instructions:
Inferior incision - Is made above the level of the This flap helps in prevention of crusting of the ex-
choana. It is carried down to the nasal septum posed nasal septal cartilage. This flap is harvested
and just above the maxillary crest, all the way from the other side after creating a septal window
forward to meet the vertical limb of the superior by excising the septal cartilage. It is used to cover
incision. If a larger flap is needed then this in- the exposed cartilage.
cision can be carried even along the floor of the
nasal cavity.
306
Endoscopic hypophysectomy
History:
308
The roof of the sphenoid (planum sphenoidale) hormones are indications for early surgery to
anteriorly is continuous with the roof of ethmoid- achieve endocrinological cure.
al sinus. At the junction of the roof and posterior
wall of sphenoid the bone is thickened to form Patients with suspected aneurysm should under-
the tuberculum sella. Inferior to the tuberculum go angiography.
sella on the posterior wall is the sella turcica. It
forms a bulge in the midline. The bone over the
sella could be 0.5 - 1 mm thick. This may get thin-
ner inferiorly. It is hence easy to breech the sella
in this tinnest part. This area can be easily identi-
fied by a bluish tinge of the dura which is visible
through the thin bony covering.
310
Complications: stripping of sphenoid mucosa, trauma to cavern-
ous sinus, trauma to internal carotid artery. Per-
1. CSF leak sistent post op bleeding could be caused due to
trauma to sphenopalatine artery and its branches.
2. Diabetes insipidus
Intrasellar hematoma: Transient / permanent loss
3. Intrasellar hematoma of vision may be caused due to intrasellar hema-
toma / or due to direct damage to optic chiasma.
4. Death due to trauma to internal carotid artery In cases of intrasellar hematoma, CT scan should
be done to clinch the diagnosis. Immediate evac-
5. Blindness due to damage to optic nerve uation of heamatoma should be done.
Introduction
312
fractured bone edges and the point where the an-
terior ethmoidal artery enter the lateral lamella in
the place of least resistance in the entire skull base
that a CSF fistula can occur.
Hyposmia or anosmia:
Image showing routes of CSF leak
Hyposmia or anosmia is due to olfactory nerve
Normal pressure leaks: damage from fracture of the cribriform plate.
Accidental trauma in the most common etiolo- Cerebral – dural scar that sealed the scar did not
gy (80%)12 of CSF leaks. Leaks occur in 23% of provide reliable barrier to infection.
patients with closed head injury and it 30% of pa- Growing fractures of the ethmoid leading to
tients with skull base fractures. CSF rhinorrhoea the formation of a herniated encephalocele that
may occur directly through the anterior cranial stretched and ruptured as a result of intracranial
fossa or indirectly from the middle or posterior pulsations.
fossa through the eustachean tube. Most frequent
sites of CSF rhinorrhoea are Fovea ethmoidalis,
Cribriform plate posterior wall of frontal sinus
and Sphenoid sinus. Because the anterior cranial
fossa dura adherent to the bone is easily torn by
HAND KERCHIEF TEST Beta trace protein is a another brain specific pro-
A wet hand kerchief that dries without stiffening tein produced mainly in the leptomeninges and
suggestive of CSF leak. choroid. It is the second most abundant protein in
CSF after albumin. It can also found in serum and
GLUCOSE OXIDASE TEST STRIPS perilymph . Beta trace protein is a reliable marker
for detection of CSF in nasal secretions and it is
The test strips are positive at a relatively low level used most commonly in Europe.
of glucose. Reducing substances in the lacrimal
gland secretions and nasal mucus may cause a GLUCOSE CONCENTRATION:
positive reaction. Hence a negative test excludes
the present of CSF but a positive result cannot be Glucose more than 30mg /dl or two thirds of
interpreted except in the presence of CSF infec- blood glucose in clear nasal fluid indicates the
tion. presence of CSF in the nasal discharge.
314
the use of contrast (or) spinal puncture. On the
HIGH RESOLUTION CT ( HRCT ) T2 weighted fast spin echo the CSF has a char-
acteristic bright signal that can generally dis-
HRCT provides thin sections (0.61mm) in both tinguished from inflammatory paranasal sinus
the axial and coronal planes. The axial images secretions. MRC is consider positive if herniation
shows the posterior wall of frontal sinus and of brain tissue or arachnoids through a bony
sphenoid sinuses. Coronal images shows the defect and CSF signal in the paranasal sinuses
ethmoid complex, roof of sphenoid sinus and the continues with CSF in the sub – arachnoid space.
tegmen of the middle ear. HRCT is able to identi- MRC is superior to CTC in cases of Multiple
fy even the smallest bone defect along with skull dural defects.
base with high sensibility. HRCT is independent
on leak activity at the time of imaging. RADIONUCLIDE CISTERNOGRAM (RNC):
Most CSF leaks resulting from accidental and The arguments against antibiotic prophylaxis are
surgical trauma heal with conservative measures The antibiotics commonly used penetrate CSF
over poorly. If the antibiotics are used a combination
a period of 710 days . Conservative management of cotrimazole which is bactericidal in CSF and
consists of Bed rest with head end elevation, amoxicillin or penicillin which are bactericidal in
Avoidance of straining activities such as nose nasal mucosa is recommended.
blowing, sneezing and coughing.
Antibiotics may promote resistant strains of
Use of laxatives and stool softeners to reduce organisms within the nasopharynx and conse-
straining. quently lead to infection with resistant or unusual
organisms.
If the leak does not resolve within 3 days inter-
mittent or continuous drainage of CSF may be Surgical Management:
tried for the next 4 days with removal of 150ml/
day. Continuous CSF drainage is hazardous and The surgical management of CSF Rhinorrhoea
should be used in caution . Over drainage can can be divided into intracranial and extra cranial
lead to intracranial aeroceles, severe brain dis- approaches. Dandy described the first surgical
placement and coma. Intermittent drainage of 20 repair through a bifrontal craniotomy in 1929 .
30ml over and 8 hour period into a closed system
is safer. Dohlman was the first to document the first
A nontraumatic high pressure leaks caused by intracranial repair of CSF leak in 1948 .In 1981
increased intracranial pressure will probably Wigand described closure of CSF leak using an
resolve if the intracranial pressure is normalized. endoscopic approach . Majority of traumatic
Intra cranial pressure can be normalized by use of CSF fistulas heal without surgical intervention.
diuretics Patients who develop CSF rhinorrhoea, shortly
316
after trauma do not need surgery to close the CSF las may be repaired through a Trans labyrinthine
fistula. approach. If the hearing is intact, they should be
approached via the posterior fossa.Leaks from the
Indications for early surgery are: sphenoid sinus area are difficult to approach via
the intracranial route.
Penetrating injury including gunshot wounds.
Intra cranial surgery is indicated when operating
Anterior cranial fossa surgery indicated for other for associated craniofacial injuries.
reasons such as intracranial hematoma or to
repair compound facial fractures with accessible Large bone defects that may be difficult to repair
dural tears being treated at the same time. endoscopically.
318
Image showing on lay grafting process Image showing underlay grafting technique
The onlay technique is generally employed for Bath plug technique of closing CSF leak:
defects located in the lamina cribrosa where the
presence of olfactory nerve filaments make it dif- Once the defect has been prepared the skull
ficult to dissect dura from the adjacent skull base. base defect is measured. If the size of the defect
is measured if the size of the defect is less then
Cartilage or bony graft is placed on the extra cra- 12mm a fat plug is harvested from the ear lobe.
nial surface of the skull duraplasty is then com- If the defect is larger than 12mm, fat is obtained
pleted with a second layer of free muco perichon- either from the region of the greater trocanter
drium. This technique can also be used in lateral of the thigh or from the abdomen. The fat of the
wall of extensively pneumatized sphenoid sinus. ear lobe is preferred because the fat globules are
tightly bound and easy to work with. The fat plug
Underlay technique: should be the same diameter as the defect and
1.5 to 2cm long. A free mucosal graft is harvested
This is ideal for defects located in the fovea eth- from the lateral nasal wall (usually on the oppo-
moidalis. Graft material is positioned between the site side of CSF leak)
dura and the bone. A 4 – 0 vicryl is knotted through the one end of
the fat and the suture passed down the length of
fat plug. The fat plug is placed below the defect
and a malleable frontal sinus probe in used to
introduce the fat plug through the defect , once
the fat plug has been safely introduced the plug is
stabilized with the probe and the suture is gently
320
a vertical limb which splits the upper lip. The
Lateral Rhinotomy vertical limb is given just lateral to the philtrum
of the upper lip to facilitate better healing without
This approach is one of the most commonly used excessive scar formation.
technique for exploration of difficult to remove
sinonasal masses. Despite the fact that endoscop- Lip splitting incision can be used to access the
ic approaches and tools has progressed rapidly bony architecture of the middle third of the face.
during the past decade, the excellent exposure Incision begins just below the medial canthus of
provided by lateral rhinotomy makes it a very the eye along the lateral edge of the nasal bone
suitable approach for resection of sinonasal mass- and frontonasal process of maxilla. Incision
es with extensive spread. should stay as close to the lateral nasal sulcus as
possible. Angular vessels could be encountered,
This is an established approach to the midfacial and the same should be ligated / cauterized to
skeleton. The standard incision is placed over the control the bleed. On deepening this incision
nasofacial groove. the lateral wall of the nose can be everted and the
interior of the nasal cavity is exposed. If lip split-
Indications: ting incision is used the skin flap can be elevated
in such a manner in order to expose the anterior
Generally few these days because of the populari- wall of the maxilla, pyriform aperture and the
ty of endoscopic sinus surgery. interior of the nasal cavity.
Incision:
322
Surgical approaches to Nasopharynx access nasopharynx.
1. Extent of tumor
2. Surgical expertise
3. Facilities available
2. Inferior approach
3. Lateral approach
Anterior approaches:
324
accessed by raising palatal mucoperiosteal flap off
the hard palate, separating the soft palate from
its bony portion. The posterior edge of bony hard
palate is removed as much as it is necessary to
access the nasopharynx. Greater palatine neuro-
vascular bundle must be mobilized bilaterally to
prevent flap necrosis.
Introduction:
Bilateral intercartilagenous infiltration extending
This approach which was popularised by Cas- around the dorsum of the nose, and the anterior
son et al and Conley is best suited for inferiorly wall of maxilla on both sides, up to the glabella of
located tumors with minimal ethmoidal involve- frontal bone.
ment. This is more suited for bilateral lesions.
This procedure is not suited for extensive tumors
which extent higher into the anterior labyrinth Transcutaneous injection into the orbit along its
with involvement of frontal sinus area. medial wall
Procedure:
Sublabial infiltration from the third molar across
This surgery is ideally performed under general the midline to the opposite third molar
anesthesia. Bilateral temporary tarsorraphy is per-
formed. The area of surgery is liberally infiltrated
with 1% xylocaine mixed with 1 in 200,000 units Trans oral greater palatine injection is also given
adrenaline. Infiltration minimizes troublesome
bleeding during surgery. The areas to be infiltrat-
ed include: The procedure is started with complete transfix-
ion incision, which is connected to bilateral in-
tercartilagenous incisions. Elevation of soft tissue
Subperichondrial plane of nasal septum from the nasal dorsum is performed through the
intercartilagenous space. The soft tissue elevation
over dorsum of nose is continued over the anteri-
Membranous portion of nasal septum or wall of maxilla on both sides. Elevation of soft
tissue should also continue over the glabella and
frontal bone. Supero laterally the elevation should
Inferior and middle turbinates on both sides extend up to the medial canthal region. The
intercartilagenous incision is extended laterally
and caudally across the floor of the vestibule to
Nasal tip be connected with the transfixation incision. This
results in a full circum vestibular incision on both
sides.
Nasal spine
After the transnasal incisions are completed the
sublabial incision is performed. It extends from
Floor of the nose on both sides the first molar on one side across the midline
up to the first molar on the opposite side. This
326
incision can be extended up to the third molar if
more exposure is needed. The incision is carried
down the submucosa, and muscles over anterior
wall of maxilla. At the pyriform aperture region
this incision is connected to intranasal incisions.
Periosteal elevators are used to elevate the soft
tissue over the anterior walls of both maxilla
up to the level of the orbital rim taking care to
protect the infraorbital vessels and nerve. The
entire midfacial skin is stripped from the dorsum
of the nose and anterior wall of maxilla. This flap
includes the lower lateral cartilages, columella
with its medial crura. The elevation is continued
till the level of glabella superiorly and medial
canthus laterally. The bony nasal pyramid and
the attached upper lateral cartilages are exposed
completely. Two rubber drains (Penrose type) are
passed through the nose and upper lip and are
used to retract the midfacial flap along with the
upper lip. Once in every 15 minutes one of the Image showing mucosal incision for midfacial
drain should be released to allow blood supply to degloving approach
the middle portion of the upper lip.
The anterior wall of the maxilla is drilled out.
Infraorbital neurovascular bundle should be
identified and preserved. Bone removal continues
superomedially towards the ethmoidal complex.
Nasolacrimal sac and duct need to be managed
before bony cuts of maxillectomy are performed.
Nasolacrimal duct can be transected at the orbital
floor level.
Epiphora
328
Transpalatal approach to Nasopharynx: the palate via greater palatine foramen bilaterally
at the posterior edge of the hard palate.
Introduction:
Procedure:
Wilson in 1951 described this approach. This ap-
proach gives exposure to nasopharynx as well as Before embarking on the surgical procedure, 1%
extensions into the sphenoid sinus and choana. It xylocaine with 1 in 100,000 adrenaline is infil-
gives no visible scar and post op healing is good. trated along upper dental alveolar ridge of hard
This approach is useful in dealing with masses in palate. Throat should be packed with roller gauze
the nasopharynx with minimal extension into the to prevent aspiration.
choana and sphenoid sinus.
Patient is put in tonsillectomy position. A for-
ward curved incision is made just in front of the
Indications: junction of hard and soft palate. Mucoperios-
teum is separated either way. Posterior spine of
JNA stage I the hard palate is removed. Incision is extended
laterally and downwards on either side along the
Small nasopharyngeal tumors pterygomandibular raphe. The mucosa of the
lateral pharyngeal wall is not divided and care is
Contraindications: taken not to damage the greater palatine vessels.
A good view of nasopharynx is achieved in this
Tumors extending to nasopharyngeal side walls. procedure. The mucous membrane on the side
of the growth is incised with a blunt knife. Thus
Preparation: with blunt dissection the periosteum is elevated,
growth is separated and finally avulsed in one
1. Preoperative emboliization for JNA / vascular piece.
lesions
Anesthesia:
General anesthesia.
Anatomy:
330
Weber Fergusson incision:
Open surgical approaches to anterior skull base:
In patients with malignant tumors infiltrating the
Adequate exposure of anterior skull base usually lateral maxillary wall a total maxillectomy should
requires a combined intracranial and extra-cra- be performed via a Weber-Fergusson incision.
nial approach. Commonly a team of neurosur- This approach involves an extension of the lat-
geons and otolaryngologists usually perform this eral rhinotomy incision by including splitting of
procedure. The choice of extra-cranial approach upper lip. This incision permits complete expo-
depends on the site and extent of the tumor and sure of maxilla from the upper alveolar ridge to
aesthetic considerations. Most importantly it also the orbit. This allows exposure of the superior
depends on the experience of the surgeon with and inferior aspects of maxilla and its complete
the chosen approach. en bloc resection. The soft tissue of the cheek is
raised from the anterior walls of maxilla, tran-
Extent of exposure of these approaches include secting the infra-orbital nerves and vessels if the
frontal sinus anteriorly, the clivus posteriorly, the superior and inferior aspects of the maxilla need
frontal lobe superiorly, and the paranasal sinuses to be approached. Upper cheek flap is developed
, the pterygo-maxillary fossa and infratemporal laterally and superiorly up to the level of the
fossa inferiorly. The lateral boundaries of this inferior orbital rim and the maxillary tuberosity.
approach include both superior orbital walls. Inferiorly it can reach the pterygomaxillary fossa.
Lateral rhinotomy - This approach is used in This incision is very rarely used now a days as
tumors involving nasal cavity and maxillary sinus a sole approach. It can be used as an extension
without palatal invasion. Benign tumors with of the Weber-Fergusson incision. This incision
anterior maxillary wall involvement can also be extends along the lower border of the eyebrow /
similarly approached. This approach allows for in a skin crest along the upper eyelid, allowing it
wide exposure of maxillary antrum, nasal cavity, to be concealed at the hair skin junction. If the
ethmoidal sinuses, and sphenoid sinus. The facial incision is made inside the eyebrow it could leave
incision extends along the lateral border of the a thick and noticeable scar, giving poor cosmetic
nose, about 1 cm lateral to the midline. Superi- results. This incision can be extended laterally
orly it starts from just below medial canthus of up to the level of the lateral canthus, or inferiorly
they and extends down through the skin crest can be extended to include the lateral rhinotomy
bordering the nasal ala. It is continued towards incision.
the philtrum. The flaps can be developed to the
level of maxillary tuberosity laterally, the upper
gingival sulcus inferiorly, the frontal sinus and
infraorbital rim superiorly and to the nasion and
nasal septum medially.
332
otomy is performed. Craniotomy includes the
frontal bone ffrom the level of the glabella below
to roughly 4-5 cm above the skull base superiorly.
Lateral borders of the craniotomy are the midpu-
pillary line bilaterally. The dura is incised next
and if needed the frontal lobes can be retracted
superiorly thereby exposing the anterior skull
base from above. The final stage of the surgery
include resection of the tumor, which extends
through the cribriform plate.
Image showing Bicoronal flap being elevated Image showing pericranial flap (Horse shoe
shaped) being raised
334
Image showing frontal lobe of brain exposed
Image showing Burr holes created in the frontal after dural excision
bone. Three holes in a triangular form is created
and bone cuts made connecting these holes ele-
vating a triangular shaped frontal bone flap.
336
Laryngology
History: Cornelio Celsus Roman physician was 6. Tonsillitis associated with abscessed nodes.
the first person to describe tonsillectomy in
1st century BC. Surgical removal of tonsils has 7. Infectious mononucleosis with severely ob-
been practised as long as three thousand years structing tonsils that is unresponsive to medical
as per Hindu literature. Versalius (1543) was the management.
first one to describe the tonsil in detail includ-
ing its blood supply. Pare in 1564 designed an
equipment that allowed placing an oval shaped
instrument around the uvula to cut it off by Obstruction:
strangulation. This instrument underwent further
modification by Hildanus in 1646. Physick (USA) 1. Sleep apnoea
in 1828 created the first tonsillotome. From 1909
tonsillectomy surgery became a common and safe 2. Adenotonsillar enlargement associated with cor
surgical procedure. It was Cohan who adopted pulmonale, and failure to thrive
ligature of bleeding vessels to control periopera-
tive hemorrhage. Another instrument that gained 3. Dysphagia
popularity was the Sluder’s guillotine.
4. Speech abnormalities (Rhinolalia clausa)
1. One week course of antibiotics (Surgery should Rose position. This position was first described by
not be performed during acute infections involv- a Theatre Nurse “Rose” hence the name. In this
ing tonsils as this would increase complications). position the head and neck are extended by keep-
ing a small sandbag under the shoulder blades of
2. Parent counseling regarding post operative care the patient.
of the child It can actually be performed as a day
care procedure. Advantages of Rose position:
4. INR Procedure:
5. Blood grouping and Rh typing The mouth of the patient is opened using Boyle
Davis mouth gag. This mouth gag is held in
position using a “M” stand / Draffin Bipod. This
ensures that the patient’s mouth is kept open by
Anesthesia: the instrument and both the hands of the surgeon
are free.
General anesthesia - Orotracheal / Nasotracheal
intubation Nasotracheal intubation is not possi- The oral cavity of the patient is cleared off secre-
ble in the presence of enlarged adenoids because tions using a Yanker’s suction tip. The tonsil is
it could cause trauma to adenoid with resultant medialized using a tonsil holding forceps (vulsel-
bleeding. If orotracheal intubation is preferred lum). Tonsil holding forceps is held in the left
then the tube can be anchored in the middle to hand to medialize right tonsil and right hand to
338
medialize the left tonsil. A little bit of ambidex-
terity will help the surgeon a lot. CryoTonsillectomy:
After medialization of tonsil mucosal incision is Tonsillectomy can also be performed using a cryo
made medial to the anterior pillar using a toothed probe. CryoSurgery is a process in which very
forceps (Waugh’s tenaculum forceps). The inci- cold instrument or substance is applied to ton-
sion is deepened and rounded along the superior sil and it is removed by the process of repeated
pole of tonsil freeing it. A cotton ball is inserted freezing and thawing. The temperature reached
inside the superior pole and is pushed gently during cryo is dependent on the medium used
peeling the tonsil off its capsule. After the tonsil : - 82 degrees centigrade by carbondioxide - 196
is peeled till the tonsillo lingual sulcus it is snared degrees centigrade by liquid nitrogen Any of the
and removed using Eve’s tonsillar snare. Using above can be used in tonsil surgery. The major
Eve’s tonsillar snare reduces bleeding because it advantage of this procedure is minimal bleeding.
crushes and cuts the tonsillar tissue. Crushing The major disadvantage of this procedure is the
the tissue ensures that tissue thromboplastin is operating time involved. This procedure is used
released facilitating coagulation. only in patients with known bleeding diathesis.
340
Delayed complications: Are mostly due to infec-
tions. These commonly occur a week after the
surgery. Bleeding during this period is known
as secondary haemorrhage. Antibiotics are used
to control infections. Conventional Cold steel
tonsillectomy.
342
Image showing patient in Rose position with
mouth open and nasotracheal tube in position
Image showing empty tonsillar fossa following
surgery
344
Investigations: can be diagnosed clinically by the presence of
bifid uvula. Hence the presence of bifid uvula is a
X-ray chest PA relative contra indication for adenoidectomy. The
largest size St Clair Thompson adenoid curette
Complete Hemogram should be introduced under the soft palate to
engage the adenoid tissue. The head of the patient
Bleeding time / Clotting time is stabilized using the non dominant hand. The
adenoid is curetted out with a single firm scraping
INR motion from superiorly to inferiorly. The adenoid
bed is examined for any remnant tissue using a
The author advocates one course of pre op antibi- dental mirror. Nasopharynx is packed with gauze.
otic therapy preferably with Amoxycillin. After a few minutes the gauze can be removed
safely and bleeding would have stopped.
Anesthesia:
346
Image showing coblation adenoidectomy
Quinsy usually occurs near the superior pole This condition should be differentiated from:
of the palatine tonsil, just outside the tonsillar
capsule between the superior constrictor and the Intratonsillar abscess
palatopharyngeus muscles. It should be noted
that quinsy could be closely related to tonsillar Peritonsillar cellulitis
artery, internal carotid artery and facial arteries.
Hence during incision and drainage adequate Infectious mononucleosis
care should be taken not to give a deep incision
to drain the abscess. The role of emergency care Odontogenic infections Aneurysm of internal
physician is to identify this condition, render ap- carotid artery
propriate treatment and provide adequate follow
up till the patient recovers fully. Intraoral ultrasound:
4. Drooling of saliva because it is very painful for A mixture of aerobic and anaerobic bacteria can
the patient to even swallow saliva be isolated from the pus drained from quinsy. The
common aerobic organism isolated being Strep-
348
tococcus group A, beta-hemolytic streptococci This is more used as a proof for the present of pus
group C and G and staphylococcus aureus. The before proceeding to perform incision and drain-
common anaerobic bacteria isolated from pus age. The pus can be sent for culture and sensitivity
aspirated from peritonsillar infections include in order to decide on antibiotic cover that should
Fusobacterium Necrophorum. This organism is be provided post operatively.
gram negative obligate anaerobic pleomorphic
rod. 2. Incision and drainage: This is performed with
patient in sitting position to prevent aspiration
Pathophysiology: of pus into the larynx. First the oral cavity and
throat of the patient is sprayed with 4 % topi-
Infection usually starts in the crypta magna from cal xylocaine spray to anaesthetize the mucosa.
where it spreads beyond the confines of the cap- A Saint Claire Thompson quinsy forceps, or a
sule causing peri tonsillitis initially, and periton- guarded 11 blade can be used. The 11 blade is
sillar abscess later. Another proposed mechanism guarded to prevent the blade from penetrating
is necrosis and pus formation in the capsular area, the tonsillar substance deeply and damaging
which then obstructs the weber glands, which underlying vital structures like internal carotid
then swell, and the abscess forms. artery. Guarding can be done by applying tape
over the entire length of the blade save the 3 mm
Weber’s glands: tip portion which is left exposed. If a blade is used
to drain quinsy then after penetrating the abscess
These are mucous (minor) salivary glands pres- a sinus forceps or a small curved artery forceps
ent in the space superior to the tonsil, in the soft should be introduced via the incision and dilated
palate. There are 20 - 25 such glands in this area. in order to ensure that pus drains freely. Site of
These glands are connected to the surface of the incision: Is commonly over the point of maxi-
tonsil by ducts. The glands clear the tonsillar area mum bulge. It can also be made at the junction
of debris and assist with the digestion of food between a horizontal imaginary line drawn from
particles trapped in the tonsillar crypts. If Weber’s the base of the uvula to the anterior pillar and a
glands become inflamed, local cellulitis can devel- vertical imaginary line drawn along the anterior
op. Inflammation causes these glands to swell up pillar. After incision is made a sinus forceps is
causing tissue necrosis and pus formation i.e. the introduced to complete the drainage procedure.
classic features of quinsy. These abscesses gener- Six weeks after I&D tonsillectomy is performed
ally form in the area of the soft palate, just above in this patient to prevent further recurrence. This
the superior pole of the tonsil, in the location of is known as interval tonsillectomy. Quinsy tonsil-
Weber’s glands. The occurrence of peritonsillar lectomy.
abscesses in patients who have undergone tonsil-
lectomy further supports the theory that Weber’s 3. Quinsy tonsillectomy / Hot tonsillectomy: Even
glands have a role in the pathogenesis. though some authors advocate this procedure, it
is highly risky. Bleeding will be profuse during
Management: the procedure. There is always an impending
danger of septicemia due to systemic spread of
1. Needle aspiration if the swelling is minimal. infection because the natural anatomical barriers
350
Class II / Grade II tongue tie:
Tongue Tie Release
This is also considered as an anterior tongue tie.
Tongue tie is diagnosed during physical examina- In this class the frenulum is attached just behind
tion. This is a rare (incidence 3-4%) and definite the tip of the tongue. The tongue is not heart
congenital abnormality. This can be identified by shaped but the tongue tie is clearly visible.
the fact that the tongue is anchored to the floor of
the moth by a tight band of tissue. Class III / Grade III tongue tie:
Tongue is a highly mobile organ made up of This is considered to be posteriorly attached fren-
longitudinal, horizontal, vertical and transverse ulum. A thin membrane is seen in the frenulum,
intrinsic muscle bundles. The extrinsic muscles and this is the difference between class III and
are the fan shaped genioglossus which is inserted class IV.
into the medial part of the tongue and the sty-
loglossus and hyoglossus which insert in to the Class IV / Grade IV tongue tie:
lateral portion of the tongue. Ths sublingual fren-
ulum is a fold of mucosa connecting the midline This is also a posterior tongue tie without the
of the inferior surface of the tongue to the floor of presence of thin membrane in the frenulum.
the mouth. In tongue tie the frenulum is actually These patients are able to elevate the front and
thick, tight and short. sides of the tongue but the mid tongue cannot
be elevated. This type of tongue tie is commonly
Tongue tie can be diagnosed in an infant who has missed.
difficulty in protruding the tongue over the lower
lip and gum ridge. This commonly cause pain and Problems due to tongue tie:
soreness of nipple while the baby is breast fed.
Classification of Tongue tie: 1. Infants with tongue tie have difficulty in breast
feeding as the mother will develop sore nipples
Tongue tie is classified into 4 grades. Grades 1 because the child finds it difficult to attach its
and 2 are anteriorly attached frenulum while in mouth to the nipple. This would result in the
grade 3 and 4 the frenulum is posteriorly at- mother terminating breast feeding prematurely
tached. causing various problems to the child.
Class I / Grade I tongue tie: 2. Speech defects can also occur due to tongue tie.
This can cause dysarthria
This is the real tongue tie and the tongue is clas-
sically heart shaped. The frenulum attaches to the Treatment:
tip of the tongue hindering tongue movement to
a great extent. This is indicated if the child has feeding problems
The child has speech problems (dysarticulation)
Frenotomy:
2. Bleeding
Frenuloplasty:
352
Image showing sutures being applied
The timing of tracheostomy is usually controver- Cartilage is a tubular structure which is partially
sial. That is the reason behind Moser’s indication made up of cartilage and partly membranous. It
for tracheostomy which states that “one should connects the larynx superiorly (cricoid cartilage
perform tracheostomy the moment he thinks of larynx to be precise) and the two main bronchi
about it”. Many surgeons swear by this Mosher’s inferiorly. Cricoid cartilage is the only complete
dictum. Advances in surgical techniques and cartilage of the entire human airway. Even the
intubation procedures have managed to decrease tracheal cartilages are incomplete posteriorly and
the risks involved in performing tracheostomy. is closed by tracheal membrane.
Ideally all tracheostomies should be performed It is the lower edge of cricoid cartilage that de-
354
fines the beginning of the trachea. This is the
most critical area of the entire airway. Cricoid
cartilage is signet ring shaped cartilage. The
mucous membrane lining the interior of cricoid
cartilage is highly sensitive to injury and irrita-
tion. Significantly irritation / injury in this area
causes fibrosis leading on to stenosis of the airway
at the subglottic level.
sion and1.8 cm in sagittal dimension. of trachea to pull the cartilaginous C arms togeth-
er.
At birth the cross-sectional lumen of trachea is
more or less circular. As the child grows into an As the individual ages or in the presence of ob-
adult the lumen takes an ovoid form. If the lumen structive air way disorder, the lateral diameter of
is circular even in an adult it should be consid- the lumen tends to narrow, while the anteroposte-
ered as an adult variant. The luminal diameter of rior diameter increases.
trachea varies with alterations in the intraluminal This causes the classic “saber sheath” trachea. The
pressure. These alterations are known to occur walls of this tracheal formation may show trache-
during: al wall calcification.
356
breaths out. corresponding tracheal arteries from the contra-
lateral side. This segmental arrangement of blood
Histology of luminal mucosa: supply limits circumferential tracheal dissection
to no more than 1-2 cm on either side of a tra-
The lumen of trachea is lined by ciliated pseu- cheal anastomosis due to devascularization and
dostratified columnar epithelium. This epitheli- ischemia.
um contains mucous secreting Goblet cells. This
mucosa also has ducts that
connect mucous glands in the submucosa to the
surface of tracheal lumen. The surface mucous
and cilia act in unison to trap and expel particles
/ microbes that could enter the airway. Some-
times air borne irritants can cause temporary /
permanent damage to this muco ciliary clearance
mechanism.
358
position posterolateral to the corresponding com-
mon carotid arteries. The right and left recurrent
laryngeal nerves are branches of vagus nerves and
they go on to innervate the true vocal cords. They
enter the larynx between the thyroid and cricoid
cartilages under the inferior horn or cornua of
thyroid cartilage.
A number of large blood vessels lie in close prox- The azygos vein courses superiorly along the right
imity to the trachea and should always be respect- anterior aspect of trachea. This vein courses supe-
ed during tracheal surgeries. The brachiocephalic riorly along the right side of the thoracic vertebral
artery / innominate artery is the first branch of Column before bending anteriorly to join the
the aortic arch. The innominate artery runs from superior vena cava lateral and just superior to the
left to right along the anterior surface of trachea. right tracheobronchial angle. During mediasti-
This occurs at the right anterolateral portion of noscopy this landmark should not be confused
the distal and middle third of trachea. with that of an enlarged node because inadver-
tent attempt at biopsy in this area would lead to
The left common carotid artery is the next branch torrential bleeding.
of the aorta. It starts to the left of the trachea’s
midline and runs superiorly from right to left
over the left anterolateral trachea. The superior
vena cava courses towards the right atrium along
the right anterior aspect of the trachea.
360
Image showing the relationship between large blood vessels and trachea
cated in all cases of upper airway obstruction ir- 3. For bronchial toileting: Chronically ill patients
respective of the cause as an emergency life saving who do not have sufficient energy to couch out
procedure. It is also indicated in impending upper bronchial secretions may have to undergo trache-
airway obstruction as in the case of angioneurotic ostomy with the primary air of sucking out the
oedema of larynx. bronchial secretions through the tracheostome.
362
Bjork’s flap can safely be created only in elective
Types of Tracheostomy tracheostomies and not under emergency setting.
This flap can be created with minimal complica-
1. Temporary tracheostomy: This life saving tions but needs some amount of patience on the
procedure is usually performed as a temporary part of the operating surgeon to perform.
measure to secure the airway while perform-
ing complex head and neck surgical procedures Contraindications for performing Bjork’s flap:
which involve airway sharing with the anesthetist.
Securing the airway electively also helps in pre- 1. In pediatric tracheostomies. The amount of
venting post-operative airway obstructions. cartilage present in the trachea of children is so
less that adjacent vital structures could well be
Indications: damaged when this flap is attempted.
2. This procedure is best avoided when tracheos-
a. Prior to any complex head and neck surgeries tomy is performed to secure air way in patients
where airway is under threat with laryngeal malignancies because it is usually
b. To tide over problems caused by impending performed as an emergency procedure.
airway obstruction due to oedema involving 3. Ideally not performed in an irradiated neck
mucosal lining of supraglottis / glottis / subglottis because the skin would be thickened and the
areas. tracheal cartilage would have undergone fibrotic
c. When airway is threatened due to the presence changes. Any attempt to create cartilage flap in
of Foreign bodies these patients would invariably result in a failure.
d. In ICU setting where the patient needs to be 4. In obese patients the neck is short and it would
kept on ventilator for more than 7 days. be difficult to create a Bjork flap of sufficient size
e. In patient’s with altered sensorium / coma to 5. If a surgeon is alone performing tracheostomy
keep the lower airway free of secretions. then Bjork’s flap is ideally avoided
Before start of surgery the patient should be At this stage it would be useful to identify the
premedicated with sedatives and anxiolytics. This cricoid cartilage to assess where exactly trachea
will ensure better co-operation on the part of the should be opened. Tracheostomy is usually
patient. performed between the 3rd and the 4th tracheal
rings. A small amount of 2% xylocaine with 1 in
The incision is usually transverse in elective 100000 adrenaline is infiltrated into the trachea
tracheostomy and vertical in emergency setting. to suppress the cough reflex if the surgery is being
The incision is given at the half way mark be- performed under local anesthesia.
tween the lower border of cricoid cartilage and
the suprasternal notch. The incision is usually 3 In order to perform Bjork’s flap, the tracheal
cm long and may even be extended if needed. The incision should be inverted U shaped one. The
skin and subcutaneous fat are dissected out and transverse portion of the U incision is made in
are held away from the field by using retractors. the intercartilagenous zone between the second
Langenbeck retractors are used for this purpose. and third tracheal cartilages. This step is usually
If the surgeon is performing the surgery alone performed using a 15 blade. The downward ver-
then self-retaining retractor is ideal. tical incisions are then performed ideally using
scissors. The vertical limbs of the incision go
Blunt dissection is performed along the midline through the 3rd and 4th tracheal rings. The first
of neck pushing away the strap muscles from tracheal ring should be avoided because of the
midline. The isthmus of thyroid gland comes into fear of subglottic stenosis.
the field when the soft tissues and muscles are
retracted from the midline. The isthmus is divid- The cartilage flap is stitched to the subcutaneous
ed and tied using diathermy and silk. The anterior tissue. Suction is applied through the tracheos-
wall of trachea becomes visible. Trachea can easi- tome to clear the secretions. Appropriate sized
ly be identified by its rings. The pretracheal fascia portex cuffed tracheostomy tube is introduced.
364
The tube is anchored by tying the tape. Cuff is
inflated.
Therapeutic indications:
Contraindications:
Image showing Bjork flap anchored to the skin 2. Permanent or end tracheostomy - This is done
around the stoma in patients who have underwent total laryngecto-
my. This is also known as the end tracheostomy.
The main advantage of Bjork’s flap tracheostomy Here after the removal of larynx, the proximal
is during post-operative management of these end of trachea is anchored to the skin. Patient
patients. The tracheostomy tube can easily be needs to live the entire duration of the life by
removed cleaned and replaced without fear of breathing through the tracheostome.
airway occlusion. There is virtually no chance of
false track creation while reinserting the trache- Major draw back in these patients is the loss of
ostomy tube after cleaning it. speech. Voice rehabilitation procedures need to
be performed in them in order at least to restore
partial speech function.
During decannulation the fistula may close rather 3. Mini tracheostomy – This procedure is one
slowly which is in fact beneficial in some patients type of cricothyroidotomy. This is commonly
in weaning them out of the tracheostomy. performed as an emergency procedure to secure
the airway as well as to prevent aspiration. Crico-
Indications include prophylactic and therapeutic thyroid membrane is incised through a vertical
indications. incision and the tracheostomy tube is introduced
through it to secure the airway.
366
Image showing Cricothyroidotomy
368
2. Routine use of fibreoptic bronchoscopy has
Advantages of percutaneous tracheostomy: been advocated.
3. The use of single beveled dilator has been sub-
1. It is a simple procedure stituted by the use of multiple dilators.
2. Very easy to perform under emergency situa-
tions Ciaglia’s procedure:
3. Can be performed easily on the bed side
4. Can be performed by paramedics The vital signs of the patient are continuously
monitored during the procedure. The patient is
Evolution of percutaneous tracheostomy: ventilated with 100% oxygen during the whole
procedure. The patient is
The first tracheostomy technique that did not sedated using a narcotic analgesic, and often a
require neck dissection was first described by non depolarising neuromuscular blocker is used.
Sheldon in 1957. He used a specially designed The neck of the patient is extended to bring up
slotted needle to blindly enter the tracheal lumen. the trachea closer to the skin.
This needle served as a guide for the introduction
of a stillete and a metal tracheostomy tube. The vertex of the patient is properly supported.
A 2 cm skin incision is located at the level of 1st
In 1969 Toyee refined this technique making it and the 2nd tracheal rings. The wound is then
incisional rather than dilational. In this technique dissected bluntly using artery forceps. The exist-
after the trachea was cannulated using a needle, ing endotracheal tube is then slowly withdrawn to
the tracheostomy tube was loaded on to a stiff a level just above the first tracheal ring, the needle
wire boogie that contained a small recessed blade. is then inserted through the incision to penetrate
This boogie along with the tracheostomy tube was the trachea between the second and the third
advanced through the needle tract thereby plac- tracheal rings.
ing the tracheostomy tube inside the trachea. This
procedure was fraught with risks and para trache- The J tipped guide wire is inserted through the
al insertions occurred commonly and hence did needle till it hits the level of carina. The needle
not become popular. is then withdrawn. Beveled plastic dilators are
introduced over this guide wire and the opening
In 1985 Ciaglia perfected the technique of percu- is dilated to create a tracheostome. When the dil-
taneous tracheostomy which is currently gaining atation is adequate a special tracheostomy tube is
popularity. He named this procedure dilational inserted over the guide wire. The dilators can be
subcricoid percutaneous tracheostomy. (PDT). used as obturators. In properly performed percu-
taneous tracheostomy the tracheostomy tube
This technique has undergone three significant will pass through the isthmus of the thyroid, there
modifications: will not be any significant bleeding because the
1. The tracheal interspace for cannulation has procedure is purely dilatational.
been moved down by two rings caudal to
the cricoid cartilage. This was done to prevent the
development of subglottic stenosis.
370
cheostomy tube is anchored in place.
Contraindications:
Since these procedures involve an already intu-
bated patient it calls for excellent coordination 1. A patient already in intense stridor.
between the surgeon and the anesthetist. 2. Laryngeal malignancies
3. Short neck individuals
Routine pre-operative ultrasound examination of 4. When proper trained personal is not available
the neck is a must because it will identify the site 5. Large thyroid gland
of an unusually large inferior thyroid veins which 6. When ultrasound reveals an abnormally large
could cause troublesome bleeding during the inferior thyroid vein.
procedure.
7. Cricothyroidotomy:
Indications:
The surgical field is sterilized by using povidone Image showing various midline landmarks on
iodine paint. Sterile towels are used to drape the the neck
neck of the patient. Local anesthesia is commonly
used to anesthetize the area of surgery. 2% xylo- With the dominant hand a large bore needle /
caine with 1 in 100000 units adrenaline is used to angiographic catheter is introduced. The needle is
infiltrate the area. The use of adrenaline ensures attached to a syringe filled with 1 ml of 2% xylo-
that the operating field is relatively blood free. caine. The needle is directed caudally at 45-degree
angle. While the needle is being advanced neg-
Identification of anatomical landmarks: This is ative pressure is applied to the syringe. If it is in
the next step in the procedure. The thyroid car- the air space air bubbles could be seen inside the
tilage should be first identified. This is the most syringe. A few drops of xylocaine is infiltrated on
prominent landmark in the neck. In males it is verifying the position of the needle by the pres-
represented by the prominent Adam’s apple. ence of air bubbles. This is done to prevent the
cough reflex.
It may be a little difficult in females, yet can be
palpated accurately. The cricoid cartilage is next If angiographic catheter is used the needle is
identified. The cricothyroid membrane lies be- withdrawn allowing the catheter to be in situ. In
tween these two cartilages. The area is stabilized the event that this catheter is not available then a
by holding the thyroid cartilage with three fingers 3 ml syringe can be used to perforate the crico-
372
thyroid membrane. After the needle is ensured
to be in position the piston of the syringe can
be withdrawn and the syringe with its needle Percutaneous Cricothyroidotomy:
attached and in place within the airway can be
connected to oxygen supply using appropriate
adapters.
374
Subcutaneous emphysema invariably to secure the airway during the threat
Obstruction of airway of impending airway obstruction.
Oesophageal / mediastinal perforation
Aspiration Surgical procedure:
Vocal fold injury
Pneumothorax Anesthesia: Under emergency situations it is per-
Laryngeal injury formed under local infiltration anesthesia. Under
Perforation of posterior tracheal wall which is elective conditions it is performed under general
membranous in nature anesthesia.
Thyroid injury
Hypercarbia (common in needle cricothyroidot- Position: Supine with neck hyperextended.
omy)
Incision: Emergency tracheostomy is performed
Late complications: with a vertical incision extending from the lower
border of cricoid cartilage up to 2cm above supra
Dysphonia sternal notch.
Infections This area is also known as the Burn’s space and is
Hematoma devoid of deep cervical fascia.
Persistent stoma
Scarring Elective tracheostomy is performed through
Glottic / Subglottic stenosis a horizontal incision at 2cm above the sternal
Laryngeal stenosis notch.
Tracheo oesophageal fistula If performed under emergency settings local
Tracheomalacia anesthesia is preferred. The drug used is 2 % xy-
locaine with 1 in 100000 adrenaline. 2 ml of this
8. High tracheostomy – Is usually performed only solution is infiltrated in to the Burns space.
during dire emergencies. It is performed between
the 1st and 2nd tracheal rings. This procedure is Through a vertical incision extending from the
not being performed these days because of the lower border of cricoid cartilage up to 2cm above
high incidence of subglottic stenosis in these the sternal notch the skin, platysma, and cervical
patients. This is ideal in patients with carcinoma fascia are incised.
larynx because the larynx can be resected along Branches of anterior jugular vein if any are ligated
with the tracheostoma there by facilitating cre- and divided. Sternohyoid and Sternothyroid mus-
ation of neo stoma in virgin tissue. cles are retracted using langenbachs retractors.
The anterior
7. Low tracheostomy – is usually performed in wall of trachea is exposed after splitting the
patients with tracheal stenosis. It is performed pretracheal fascia. The tracheal rings are clearly
between the 4th and the 5th tracheal rings. identified. Few drops of 2% xylocaine is instilled
into the trachea through a syringe. This process
8. Elective tracheostomy – This is the common- serves to desensitize the tracheal mucosa while it
ly performed tracheostomy. This is performed is being incised. Incision over the trachea is sited
1. Platysma muscle
2. Superficial cervical fascia
3. Branches of anterior jugular vein Image showing tracheal cartilage being incised
4. Sternohyoid, and Sternothyroid muscles. between the second and third tracheal rings
5. Thyroid isthmus at the level of second tracheal
ring
6. Pretracheal pad of fat through which inferior
thyroid veins may wander, and sometimes thy-
roidea ima artery may be found in this plane.
376
Advantages of metal tracheostomy tube:
1. It is cheap
2. Easy to maintain
3. Patient will be able to speak by occluding the
tube. This is possible in Fuller’s tube because of
the presence of speaking valve.
4. It is not irritating to the tracheal mucosa
5. Makes decannulation procedure easy.
Decannulation procedure:
Decannulation in adults:
Image showing Fuller’s Biflanged tracheostomy If the patient is on portex tube then it should be
tube being inserted changed into a metal one. The opening of the
tracheostomy tube is occluded using a spigot. Ini-
tially this spigetting is done during day time for
2 days. If the patient tolerates spigetting during
day time for this duration then it is kept spigetted
for full period of 24 hours. If the patient tolerates
spigetting of this duration then the tube can be
removed and the wound can be approximated
and plastered. There is also the option of surgical
closure of the tracheostome wound.
Decannulation in children:
378
trachea. If too small a tube is used then it could erative period will be a little difficult because the
cause subcutaneous emphysema. track between the tracheal stoma and skin would
3. Pneumothorax – This involves air leakage into not have formed. Hurried attempts to reinsert the
the mediastinum. This is a serious complication tube would cause it to go through a false passage.
which is caused due to inadvertent damage to api- The ideal way to reinsert the tube in these pa-
cal pleura of the lung. Right lung lies at a higher tients is to put them in neck extended position
level than the left. When the patient is hyperven- bringing the trachea forwards. The trachea can
tilating the apex of right lung will occupy lower then be visualized after retracting the soft tissues
portion of the neck. It could be damaged if the with tracheal retractor. The stoma should clearly
patient is restless on the table. This complication be visualized before attempting to reinsert the
is more common in children. Inter-coastal drain- tube.
age should be resorted to in order to tide over the 2. Infection in the trachea around the tracheos-
acute crisis. tome. (Tracheitis).
4. Damage to oesophagus. This is always associ- 3. Development of granulation tissue close to the
ated with trauma to the posterior wall of trachea. stoma. This will cause bleeding from around the
This will cause the patient to aspirate whenever tube. The granulation tissue should be removed
food / liquid is swallowed. surgically
5. Sudden apnoea immediately on opening the before decannulation could be attempted.
trachea because of carbon dioxide wash out 4. Tracheal mucosa could be damaged due to
which could reduce the respiratory drive. In this pressure from the tracheostomy tube, friction
scenario using carbogen inhalation could help. from the tube, infections.
This problem can be avoided by gradually open-
ing up the trachea by dilating the opening slowly. Delayed complications:
This will prevent sudden carbon dioxide washout.
6. Tracheostomy tube block due to inspissated These complications are due to long term pres-
secretions / blood clot. ence of tracheostomy tube inside the trachea. This
is more common when the tube is present inside
Intermediate complications: the trachea for more than
16 weeks.
1. Dislodgement of tracheostomy tube. This 1. Thinning of trachea due to the tracheostomy
accidental decannulation is common in obese tube rubbing against the tracheal mucosa. This
patients with a short neck. This happens because condition is known as tracheomalacia.
the pretracheal tissue thickness is increased in 2. Development of tracheo oesophageal fistula
these patients due to accumulation of fat. While 3. Supra stomal collapse. This condition requires
insertion the neck would have been in a hyperex- additional surgical procedure to repair it.
tended position bringing the 4. Persistent tracheo cutaneous fistula after decan-
trachea closer to the neck. After surgery when the nulation.
patient assumes normal position there is every 5. Pneumonia due to infection
chance of tube slipping out of the stoma because 6. Dislodged tube entering the airway. This is
the trachea will slip back to its normal position. common if the same tube is used for prolonged
Reinsertion of the tube in the immediate post-op- duration of time. This is an emergency. This con-
380
out of favor. The strategies for organ preservation
Total Laryngectomy surgery include horizontal partial and vertical
partial Laryngectomy. Currently supracricoid
Historical perspectives: partial Laryngectomy and near total
Laryngectomy are slowly gaining ground.
History credits Patrick Watson for having per-
formed total 1. Total Laryngectomy is still indicated in ad-
Laryngectomy. This happened way back in 1866. vanced laryngeal malignancies with extensive
Careful study of Patrick Watson’s description of cartilage destruction and extralaryngeal spread of
the case has revealed that he performed a trache- the lesion.
ostomy on a live patient and performed an autop- 2. Involvement of posterior commissure / bilateral
sy Laryngectomy on the same patient. Ironically arytenoid involvement
the patient died of syphilitic laryngitis. It was Bill- 3. Circumferential submucosal disease associated
roth from Vienna who performed the first total with / without bilateral vocal fold paralysis
Laryngectomy on a patient with growth larynx. 4. Subglottic extension of the tumor mass to in-
This happened on December 31 1873. Bottini of volve cricoid cartilage
Turin documented a long surviving patient fol- 5. Completion procedure after failed conservative
lowing total Laryngectomy (10 years). Laryngectomy / irradiation
6. Hypopharyngeal tumors originating / spread-
Gluck critically evaluated total Laryngectomy pa- ing to post cricoid area
tients and found that there were significantly high 7. Radiation necrosis of larynx unresponsive to
mortality rates (about 50%) during early post antibiotics and hyperbaric oxygen therapy
operative phases. This prompted him to perform 8. Severe aspiration following partial / near total
total Laryngectomy in two stages. In the first Laryngectomy
stage he performed tracheal separation, followed 9. Massive nodal metastasis – In these patients
by total Laryngectomy surgery two weeks later. total Laryngectomy should be accompanied by
This staging of procedure allowed for healing of block neck dissection.
tracheocutaneous fistula before the actual Laryn-
gectomy procedure. Patient selection:
In 1890’s Sorenson one of the students of Gluck Enumerated below are the patient requirements
developed a single staged Laryngectomy pro- for a successful total Laryngectomy.
cedure. He also envisaged the current popular a. Patient should be medically fit for general anes-
incision Gluck Sorenson’s incision for total Lar- thesia.
yngectomy. b. Patient should be adequately motivated for post
Laryngectomy life
c. Patient should have adequate dexterity of hands
Indications: / fingers to manage the Laryngectomy tubes
d. Positive biopsy proof is a must
With the current focus on organ preservation e. Screening for metastasis – This should include
procedures, total Laryngectomy is slowly falling CT imaging of neck
Procedure:
Incision:
382
Mobilization of larynx: sheath
Medially – Pharynx and larynx contained in the
The skin flap “U” shaped is elevated in the sub- visceral compartment of neck
platysmal plane. Dissection of the flap along with
the platysma in this plane will ensure that the
vascularity of the flap is not compromised. The
skin of the neck receives its blood supply from
the perforators of platysma muscle. The elevated
flap is stitched out of the way. The anterior jugular
vein and the prelaryngeal node of Delphian are
left undisturbed and should be ideally included
with the specimen.
384
Image showing middle thyroid vein exposed
before ligation
Image showing the recurrent laryngeal nerve
386
Removal of larynx:
388
Image showing skin flap being repositioned
Complications:
390
gical planning. factors are not included in the currently available
staging protocol.
Evaluation should include:
Types of Conservative laryngectomies:
a. Detailed history
b. Dynamic assessment of larynx – This includes There are two major classes of conservative laryn-
indirect laryngoscopic examination, video laryn- gectomy procedures. They include:
goscopic examination, stroboscopy. Vocal cord
fixation should be distinguished from arytenoid 1. Vertical partial laryngectomy
fixation which implies involvement of cricoary- 2. Horizontal partial laryngectomy – Two types
tenoid joint (a contraindication for conservative i.e. Supraglottic partial laryngectomy and supra-
procedures). cricoid partial laryngectomy
c. Static assessment of larynx – Staging laryngos-
copy Vertical partial laryngectomy:
d. Imaging – CT, MRI and PET scans
e. Head & Neck examination In this procedure the larynx is entered via a
f. Exclusion of synchronous lesion in the aerodi- midline vertical thyrotomy incision. One half
gestive tract of the larynx can be removed. There are various
g. General medical evaluation including lung modifications of this procedure in order to ensure
function tests, cardiac evaluation, nutritional complete tumor clearance.
status, motivation, rehabilitation advice.
Gorden Buck performed a laryngofissure surgery
Even though accurate staging of the tumor is a followed by complete excision of the tumor mass
must for successful conservative laryngectomy for laryngeal cancer in 1851. Solis Cohen in 1869
the currently available staging system is fraught introduced transcervical vertical partial laryn-
with a number of pitfalls. They include: gectomy and was able to achieve long term cure
for laryngeal malignancy. The goal of this surgery
1. The difference in the behavior pattern of severe is resection of a portion of thyroid cartilage with
dysplasia and carcinoma in situ is unclear and the cancer at the glottic level while preserving
is not reflected in the currently available staging the posterior paraglottic space. It is hence very
system. suitable in managing early glottic cancers (T1 &
2. Even though anterior commissure involvement T2 lesions) without the involvement of anterior
is vital in deciding the outcome of any partial commissure.
surgeries it is not reflected in the existing TNM
staging system available Variants of vertical partial laryngectomy:
3. Motion impairment of vocal folds is purely
subjective with a high degree of observer varia- A classification system has been proposed for
tion. This could lead to an erroneous staging vertical partial laryngectomy based on the extent
4. The size of the lesion and its molecular charac- of resection.
terization (over expression of p53 oncogene) are
important determinants of tumor behavior. These Type I Standard vertical
It should be stressed that failure rates are higher Advantages of laryngoflex endotracheal tube:
in patients with:
1. Its shape helps in anchoring the tube to the
1. Involvement of anterior commissure as these anterior chest wall without fear of tube migration.
tumors have a propensity to involve the subglottic 2. After insertion this tube is away from the field
area. of surgery
2. Impaired vocal cord mobility due to involve- 3. The presence of curvature prevents develop-
ment of paraglottic space i.e. Thyroarytenoid ment of excessive pressure over the stoma while
muscle involvement makes things pretty difficult. the patient is being ventilated
Procedure: Incision:
This surgery is performed under general anesthe- Gluck Sorenson incision is preferred. This inci-
sia. sion ensures adequate exposure of the surgical
field. It is a curved incision extending along the
anterior border of sternomastoid muscle from the
392
mastoid tip on both sides. In the midline incision
of both sides are joined at the level of tracheal sto-
ma. Before incising the skin it is always better to
mark the incision over the skin using skin pencil.
394
As shown in the figure a fissure burr is used to
make a vertical cut in the middle of thyroid carti-
lage beginning at the thyroid notch. Care must be
taken not to enter the larynx at this juncture. The
inner perichondrium of the thyroid cartilage is
left intact till the interior of larynx is completely
examined from below.
Two more cuts are made in the horizontal di- Image showing one half of thyroid cartilage be-
rection over the thyroid cartilage. These cuts are ing held with Babcocks forceps
made using fissure burr. The superior transverse
cut is made just below the superior border of the
thyroid cartilage and the inferior transverse cut is
made in the lower border of the thyroid cartilage
just above the level of cricoid cartilage.
Entry in to larynx:
396
ed larynx. The redundant cervical fascia can be
sewn over this muscle in order to strengthen it.
398
Indications:
Procedure:
400
spread superiorly along the petiole of the epiglot-
tis. In order to provided reliable clearance during
surgery it is prudent to include the angle of the
thyroid cartilage and either part or whole of the
epiglottis to ensure reliable tumor clearance (ex-
tended frontal partial laryngectomy).
402
the tongue can also be sacrificed.
A flap of outer perichondrium is dissected care-
Surgical technique: fully from the thyroid cartilage and reflected
downwards. This procedure exposes roughly up-
This surgery is performed under general anesthe- per 2/3 of the anterior surface of thyroid cartilage.
sia which is administered via tracheostomy. The
classic Gluck Sorenson laryngectomy incision is
preferred as it provides excellent exposure of the
neck.
Image showing outer perichondrial incision The free border of the epiglottis is grasped with
404
cial attention to the attachment of posterior and
lateral cricoarytenoid muscles. This also allows Indications:
the neoglottis to abduct / adduct postoperatively.
To ensure a good surgical outcome all the compo- 1. In T1, T2, T3, Glottic / Transglottic / supraglot-
nents of cricoarytenoid unit should be preserved. tic tumors
2. Selected T4 lesions with limited invasion of
Vocal cord fixation occurs due to the involvement thyroid cartilage without involving the outer
of paraglottic space by the tumor / invasion of perichondrium
thyroarytenoid muscle. This surgical procedure 3. Salvage surgery after failure of radiotherapy
facilitates safe excision of paraglottic space /
thyroarytenoid muscle. It also allows for complete Contraindications:
excision of lateral and posterior cricoarytenoid
muscle if the arytenoid on the tumor bearing side 1. Involvement of interarytenoid area
needs to disarticulated. 2. Fixed arytenoids
3. Involvement of mucosa over arytenoids
Procedure: 4. Subglottic extension
5. Extralaryngeal spread of the tumor
In this surgical procedure true vocal cords, false 6. Invasion of hyoid bone
cords, paraglottic space along with entire thyroid
cartilage can be excised. If need be the pre-epi- Surgical procedure:
glottic space and the epiglottis can also be in-
cluded in the resection. If during reconstruction This procedure is performed under general anes-
a CHEP is planned lower 1/3 of the epiglottis is thesia. Intubation via a preliminary tracheostomy
retained. If need be the arytenoid on the tumor will solve a lot of perioperative problems. The
bearing side can also be excised in order to secure procedure begins with the standard apron inci-
a good tumor free margin. However it is essential sion and elevation of subplatysmal flaps superi-
to conserve one intact and sensate cricoarytenoid orly up to 1cm above the level of hyoid bone and
unit and the entire cricoid cartilage. inferiorly up to the level of clavicles. The ster-
nohyoid and thyrohyoid muscles are transected
Post operative laryngeal reconstruction: along the superior border of thyroid cartilage. The
medial laryngeal vessels are ligated at this stage.
Is usually accomplished by using elements of The sternothyroid muscles are transected at the
the intact cricoarytenoid unit and a cricohyoid level of inferior border of thyroid cartilage. The
impaction. For adequate wound closure a pexy is inferior constrictor muscle and the external thy-
done between the cricoid and hyoid bone, or by roid cartilage perichondrium are transected along
using the preserved portion of the epiglottis. Non its posterior border. The pharyngeal constrictors
absorbable sutures should be used for cricohyoid should be excised close to the posterior border of
impaction. thyroid cartilage in order to protect the internal
laryngeal nerve branches.
406
13. Adrenal gland
Lingual thyroid and its management
Embryology:
Introduction:
A brief discussion of embryology of thyroid gland
Lingual thyroid is caused by a rare developmental will not be out of place as this would ensure better
disorder caused due to aberrant embryogenesis understanding of the pathophysiology involved in
during the descent of thyroid gland to the neck. the formation of ectopic thyroid gland.
Lingual thyroid is the most frequent ectopic loca-
tion of thyroid gland. Prevalence rates of lingual Initially thyroid gland appears as proliferation
thyroid vary from 1 in 100,000 to 1 in 300,000. of endodermal tissue in the floor of the pharynx
Review of literature reveals that only about 400 between tuberculum impar and hypobranchial
symptomatic cases have been reported so far. This eminence (this area is the later foramen caecum).
could well be an understatement and statistical Cells of thyroid gland descend into the mesoderm
anomaly. above aortic sac into the hypopharyngeal emi-
nence (later pharynx) as cords of cells. During
History: this descent thyroid tissue retains its communica-
tion with foramen cecum. This communication is
Hickmann recorded the first case of lingual thy- known as thyroglossal duct. This duct disappears
roid in 1869. Montgomery stressed that for a con- as soon as the descent is complete.
dition to be branded as lingual thyroid, thyroid
follicles should be demonstrated histopathologi- Thyroid gland descends in front of the hyoid bone
cally in tissues sampled from the lesion. and laryngeal cartilages. By 7th week it reaches its
final destination in front of trachea. At this time
Common locations of ectopic thyroid gland a small median isthmus develops connecting the
include: lobes of thyroid gland. The gland begins to func-
tion by the 3rd month when thyroid follicles start
1. Between geniohyoid and mylohyoid muscles to develop. Parafollicular or c cells that secrete
(sublingual thyroid) calcitonin are developed from ultimobranchial
2. Above the hyoid bone (suprahyoid prelarynge- bodies.
al)
3. Mediastimum Persistence of thyroglossal duct even after birth
4. Pericardial sac leads to the formation of thyroglossal cyst. These
5. Heart cysts usually arise from the remnants of thyro-
6. Breast glossal duct and can be found anywhere along
7. Pharynx the migration site of thyroid gland. They are
8. Oesophagus commonly found behind the arch of hyoid bone.
9. Trachea Important diagnostic feature is their midline
10. Lung location. Normal development and migration of
11. Duodenum thyroid gland needs an intact Tbx1-Fgf8 pathway.
12. Mesentery of small intestine This pathway has been identified as the key reg-
408
Image showing migration of thyroid gland
Lingual thyroid could be seen as pinkish mucosa to palpate the neck in the region of thyroid to
covered mass over the posterior third of tongue. ascertain whether normal thyroid tissue is present
On palpation this mass could be felt as solid firm in the neck.
and fixed mass. It would be seen attached to the
tongue at the junction of anterior 2/3 and poste- Investigation:
rior 1/3.
Ultrasound neck:
This is where approximately foramen cecum is
supposed to be present. Attempt should be made In all patients with lingual thyroid the presence of
CT scan:
410
Image showing Technitium 99 scan. It clear-
Image of CT scan neck axial view with contrast ly shows increased uptake in the region of the
shows absence of thyroid gland in the neck. The tongue (due to lingual thyroid tissue) and ab-
internal jugular vein and carotid artery could sence of uptake in the neck region due to absence
be seen as enhancing masses. Jugular vein of one of normal thyroid tissue in this area.
side appears to be predominantly enlarged.
Role of radio active iodine uptake studies:
Technetium 99 scan is virtually diagnostic. It will This helps in ascertaining the functional status of
clearly reveal the radioactive isotope uptake by the thyroid gland. It also helps in ascertaining the
the thyroid tissue present on the tongue. It will viability of the transplanted ectopic thyroid gland
also clearly demonstrate the presence or absence 100 days after the surgical procedure.
of thyroid tissue in the neck region.
Both I 131 and I 123 can be used for this purpose.
These images are obtained in either dynamic or I 123 has a favorable dosimetry for imaging. Since
static mode 20 minutes after intravenous injec- it is produced in a cyclotron it is rather expensive.
tion of 74-111MBq of Technitium 99 pertechne- Whereas I 131 is reactor produced and is reason-
tate. Its molecular weight is comparable to that of able cheap. It is also freely available. It has poor
iodine and is transported actively into the thyroid imaging characteristics and emits beta radiation.
tissue via the sodium iodide symporter system. Its half life is about 8 – 10 days as compared to 12
hours of I 123. Hence I 123 is preferred for func-
tioning radioactive imaging purposes.
Radioactive iodine is usually administered in
412
is proceeded in the subplatysmal plane.
Transmandibular translingual approach:
Procedure:
Advantages:
1. Excellent visualization
2. No need for ligating lingual vessels
3. Important structures are spared i.e lingual Image showing the transmandibular approach
nerve, hypoglossal nerve, and submandibular
salivary gland
The following structures are identified:
Lateral pharyngotomy approach:
1. Carotid bifurcation
This approach is preferred if transpositioning of 2. Lingual artery
lingual thyroid is planned. Anaesthesia is induced 3. Superior thyroid artery
via nasotracheal intubation. Patient is positioned 4. Hypoglossal nerve
in such a way that the neck is slightly extended.
An oblique curved incision is made about 8 cms
long in the left lateral portion of upper neck just
anterior to sternomastoid muscle. The dissection
Procedure:
414
Ryles tube should be left in place at least for 3
Incision: days.
416
After surgery all these patients should be started
on oral supplemental doses of thyroxine.
Introduction: The styloid process shows lot of Anatomy: Embryologically the styloid process
variations in its length. In majority of patients it is derived from the second branchial arch ( a
is about 20 – 30 mm long. Technically speaking component of Reichiert’s cartilage). It is a slender
when the length of styloid process exceeds 30 mm bony structure extending antero inferiorly from
then it is considered to be elongated. The clinical the petrosal aspect of temporal bone. In front of
signs and symptoms associated with elongat- the styloid process the following structures are
ed styloid process was first described by Eagle seen:
in 1937. Later this condition became known as
Eagle’s syndrome / Elongated styloid process. The 1. Internal maxillary artery
signs and symptoms of elongated styloid process 2. Lingual nerve
are pretty vague and often at best misleading. 3. Auriculotemporal nerves
These patients usually go medical shopping vis- Posterior to the styloid process the following
iting neurologists, dental surgeons, psychiatrists structures are seen:
and surgeons. The diagnosis of this condition 1. Internal jugular vein
requires awareness and vigilance. This condition 2. Internal carotid artery
can be confirmed by palpating the tonsillar fossa, 3. Cervical sympathetic chain
infiltration of local anesthetic agents and imaging 4. Last 4 cranial nerves (9,10,11, and 12)
studies.
History:
418
2. Stylohyoid muscle – laterally
3. Styloglossus muscle – anteriorly
4. Two ligaments stylohyoid and stylomandibular
also gets attached to this process
1. Elongated
2. Crooked
3. Segmented
4. Very elongated
420
Symptoms: Common symptoms associated with tion of post tonsillectomy scar tissue towards the
elongated styloid process include: elongated styloid process resulting in the im-
pingement of one or more of the following cranial
1. Vague pain in the neck nerves i.e. 5,7,9 and 10.
2. Foreign body sensation in the throat
3. Pain in the throat Carotid artery syndrome: In this type the carot-
4. Painful swallowing id arteries are intermittently compressed during
5. Pain while changing head position head turning movements of neck. Head rotation
6. Pain in the ear in these patients classically causes compression
7. Pain over temporomandibular joint of internal carotid artery and sympathetic chain
8. Pain radiating to upper limb resulting in syncope, ipsilateral headache and or-
bital pain. Compression of external carotid artery
Probable causes of stylalgia: causes pain in the distribution of temporal and
maxillary branches.
1. Fracture of ossified stylohyoid ligament –
caused by trauma, sudden laughter or epileptic Clinical tests to confirm elongated styloid pro-
seizures cess:
2. Nerve compression by elongated / malposi-
tioned styloid process. Glossopharyngeal nerve is 1. Palpation of tonsillar fossa: This elicits similar
commonly involved pain / aggravation of pre existing pain.
3. Degenerative and inflammatory changes asso- 2. Xylocaine infiltration test: Patients suspect-
ciated with elongated styloid process ed of having elongated styloid process on being
4. Irritation of pharyngeal mucosa infiltrated about 2 ml of 2% lignocaine into the
5. Impingement of carotid vessels by the elongat- tonsillar fossa have significant reduction in pain.
ed styloid process (carotidynia). A positive xylocaine infiltration test usually indi-
cates Eagle’s syndrome.
Classic features of stylalgia: include
1. Dull and nagging pain Theories of ossification of stylohyoid apparatus:
2. Pain becomes worse on deglutition
3. Pain radiates to the ear and mastoid region. In humans the cervicohyal element of second
branchial arch degenerates with time. It should be
Note: Eagle’s syndrome should be considered in noted that its fibrous sheath, which has a poten-
all patients with vague craniofacial pain. tial to ossify persists as stylohyoid ligament. The
stylohyoid process ossifies between 5-8 years
Eagle classically described two types of Symptom after birth, and any variation in this ossification
complexes. process leads to the creation of elongated styloid
process. Hence the term ossification should be
Classic Eagle’s syndrome: Commonly develops in ideally used instead of calcification.
patients following tonsillectomy. These patients
have persistent throat pain and globus pallidus.
These symptoms could be caused due to contrac-
422
is sufficient to expose and remove the styloid
process. After slitting the pharyngeal mucosa, the
tissue over styloid process is fixed with the help
of fingers. Using a Negus knot adjuster, the tissue
over the styloid process can be slit open and the
periosteum over the styloid process stripped.
Once the styloid process has been visualized it
can be removed with the help of a rongeur. After
securing perfect hemostasis the wound is closed
with absorbable sutures.
424
Tonsillar bed approach:
426
2. Causes less cosmetic deformity even when per-
Modified radical neck dissection: formed bilaterally
This category of neck dissection procedures 3. It has been shown that spinal accessory nerve
includes the various modifications that have in majority of cases is not in proximity to the
been incorporated into the procedure of radi- grossly involved nodes and hence its preservation
cal neck dissection with the intention to reduce does not compromise the oncologic soundness of
the morbidity by preserving one or more of the the surgery.
following structures: the spinal accessory nerve,
internal jugular vein and sternomastoid muscle. Indications:
Three neck dissections have been included in this
category. They differ from each other only in the 1. Used in surgical treatment of neck in patients
number of neural, vascular and muscular struc- with clinically obvious nodal metastasis
tures that are preserved.
2. In patients with multiple nodal involvement in
1. Modified radical neck dissection with preserva- various nodal levels
tion of spinal accessory nerve
3. Spinal accessory nerve should not lie close to
2. Modified radical neck dissection with preserva- the involved node
tion of spinal accessory nerve and internal jugular
vein
3. Modified radial neck dissection with preser- Modified radical neck dissection with preserva-
vation of spinal accessory nerve, internal jugular tion of spinal accessory nerve and internal jugular
vein and sternomastoid muscle. This procedure vein:
also goes by the name functional neck dissection
Modified radical neck dissection with preser- This surgery involves the dissection of node bear-
vation of spinal accessory nerve: This surgery ing tissues of one side of the neck en bloc preserv-
involves en bloc removal off lymph node bearing ing the spinal accessory nerve and the internal
tissues of one side of the neck from the inferior jugular vein. Usually this procedure is decided on
border of the mandible to the clavicle and from the table when during the course off neck dissec-
the lateral border of strap muscles to the anterior tion the Metastatic tumor in thee neck is found
border of trapezius. The spinal accessory nerve is to be adherent to the sternomastoid muscle but
preserved. The internal jugular vein and sterno- away from the accessory nerve and the internal
mastoid muscle is included in the specimen. jugular vein. This scenario occurs occasionally in
patients with hypopharyngeal / laryngeal tumors
Advantages: with metastasis under the middle third of sterno-
mastoid muscle.
1. Preservation of spinal accessory nerve prevents
frozen shoulder development Modified radical neck dissection with preserva-
tion of spinal accessory nerve, internal jugular
This surgery involves en bloc removal of lymph This involves removal of only the nodal groups
node bearing tissues of one side of neck, includ- that carry the highest risk of containing metas-
ing lymph node levels I – V preserving the spinal tasis according to the location of the primary, pre-
accessory nerve, internal jugular vein and ster- serving the spinal accessory, internal jugular vein
nomastoid muscle. It should be borne in mind and sternomastoid muscle. This procedure was
that the muscular and vascular aponeurosis of the popularized in 1960’s by surgeons at The Univer-
neck delimits compartments filled with fibroad- sity of Texas Anderson Cancer Centre.
ipose tissue. The lymphatic system of the neck
contained within these compartments can be ex- Justification for this procedure:
cised in an anatomic block by stripping the fascia
off muscles and vessels. Except the vagus nerve 1. This procedure preserves the functional and
which runs within the carotid sheath, the nerves cosmetically relevant structures.
of the neck don’t follow the aponeurotic compart-
ment distribution. The phrenic nerve and bra- 2. This procedure is also anatomically justified.
chial plexus are partially within a compartment. Studies have demonstrated that cervical metasta-
The hypoglossal and spinal accessory nerves run sis occur in predictable patterns in patients with
across compartments. Unless these nerves are squamous cell carcinomas of head and neck.
directly involved by tumor, they can be dissected
free and preserved. 3. Nodal groups frequently involved in patients
with carcinomas of oral cavity are the jugulodi-
Indications: gastric and midjugular group of nodes.
1. This surgery is the treatment of choice even in 4. Nodes of submandibular triangle are frequently
N0 neck patients with squamous cell carcinoma involved in patients with carcinoma of the floor of
of the upper aero digestive tract, especially when mouth, anterior tongue and buccal mucosa. These
the primary is in the larynx or Hypopharynx. The tumors can metastasize to both sides of the neck.
nodes of submandibular triangle are at low risk in
these patients and hence need not be removed. 5. Tumors of oral cavity metastasized most fre-
quently to the neck nodes in levels I, II, and III,
2. This surgery is indicated in the treatment of N1 whereas carcinomas of oropharynx, Hypophar-
neck when the Metastatic nodes are mobile and ynx and larynx involved mainly thee nodes in the
are no greater than 2.5 – 3 cms. levels II, III and IV.
3. This surgery is indicated in patients with well 6. Selective neck dissection provides the surgeon
differentiated carcinoma of thyroid who have with some staging information.
palpable nodal metastasis in the posterior triangle
of neck. 7. This procedure can be used for the elective
treatment of regional lymphatics with excellent
survival rates.
428
posterior border of sternomastoid muscle.
There are four selective neck dissections de-
scribed: Indications:
Selective neck dissection of level I – III: 1. This procedure in indicated in the treatment of
neck in patients with squamous cell carcinoma of
This is also known as Supraomohyoid neck the larynx, oropharynx and Hypopharynx.
dissection. If the selective dissection covers even
level IV nodes then it is known as “Extended 2. For tumors of the supraglottis and posterior
Supraomohyoid neck dissection”. The nodes re- pharyngeal wall the dissection is often bilateral.
moved are those contained in the submental and
submandibular triangles (level I), Upper jugular
region (level II), the midjugular level (level III).
The posterior limit of dissection is marked by the Selective neck dissection level VI:
cutaneous branches of cervical plexus and the
posterior border of sternomastoid muscle. The This procedure is also known as anterior neck
inferior limit is the omohyoid muscle as it crosses dissection or central compartment dissection.
the internal jugular vein. This procedure involves removal of prelaryngeal,
pretracheal as well as paratracheal nodes on both
Indications: sides.
Problems with neck dissection: 9. Apnea – Some patients become apnoeic due
to loss / diminished ventilatory responses due
1. In radical neck dissection procedures the spinal to carotid body denervation after bilateral neck
accessory nerve is removed. This causes denerva- dissection.
tion of the trapezius muscle. This muscle is one
of the most important shoulder abductors. This 10. Jugular vein thrombosis
destabilizes the scapula causing it to flare. The pa-
tient will not be able to abduct the shoulder above 11. Jugular vein blow out – Common in patients
90 degrees. The classic feature is the shoulder following post operative radiotherapy
syndrome characterized by pain, weakness and
deformity of shoulder girdle. The shoulder dys- Levels of neck nodes
function is not only due to dysfunction of spinal
accessory nerve, but also can occur secondary to Lymphatics of neck:
glenohumeral stiffness caused by weakness of the
scapulo humeral girdle muscles and post opera- Six levels are currently used to describe the
tive immobility. complete nodal anatomy of neck. The concept of
sublevels has been introduced into the classifica-
2. Cosmetic neck deformity tion because certain zones have been identified
within the six levels, which may have clinical
3. Infection significance.
4. Air leaks – This can cause flap necrosis. When Level I lymphatics: This has been further subdi-
these leaks are associated with tracheal wound vided into two sublevels.
it is sinister. Suction drain should be inserted to
prevent this complication Sublevel IA (submental) includes nodes within
the submental triangle. This triangle is bounded
5. Bleeding by the anterior bellies of digastric muscles and the
Hyoid bone.
6. Chylous fistula
Sublevel IB (Submandibular): This level includes
430
Image showing classification of Neck dissection
lymph nodes within the boundaries of anterior ary is the stylohyoid muscle, and the posterior
belly of digastric muscle, the stylohyoid muscle, boundary is the posterior border of sternomas-
and inferior border of the body of the mandible. toid muscle. Two sublevels have been identified
in this level.
Level II lymphatics: (Upper jugular) This includes
nodes located around the upper third of the inter- Sublevel IIA: Includes nodes located anterior to
nal jugular vein and spinal accessory nerve. This the vertical plane defined by the spinal accessory
extends from the skull base above to the inferior nerve.
border of hyoid bone below. The anterior bound-
432
Image showing the vertebral artery
Image showing spinal accessory nerve
434
Mandibular swing approach swing approach was the one popularized by Spiro.
This procedure is ideally performed under gen-
Introduction: eral anesthesia. Preliminary tracheostomy should
be performed because extensive intra oral oede-
The mandibular swing approach provides excel- ma following surgery will compromise airway
lent exposure for the surgical treatment of benign during early post op phases. Endotracheal tube
/ malignant lesions involving the oral cavity, intubation is performed via the tracheostome and
oropharynx and the parapharyngeal space. The the tube is anchored to the chest. A nasogastric
advantages of this procedure include: tube should be introduced before surgery.
436
Image showing stepped midline osteotomy per-
formed on the mandible
Image showing the begining of intraoral dissec- Image showing tumor mass visible after mandib-
tion. Note the Wharton’s duct has been separated ular swing
and held apart using proline. This helps in its
identification during repair.
438
Complications:
440
2. Fibreoptic light transmission system tion channel making it difficult to clean. Plasma
3. Working channel sterilization invariably is inadequate to sterilize
4. Irrigation channel these scopes.
5. Fibreoptic image transmission system
6. The outer tube covers, stabilizes and protects The recent modular endoscopes are made of Niti-
all these components without adding on to the nol steel which is more flexible than conventional
diameter of the whole system. steel. It is highly advantageous while maneu-
vering a tortuous salivary gland duct. It should
Semirigid modular endoscopes: always be borne in mind that a more rigid system
is easier to steer.
In this type of endoscope the fibers used for
transmitting light and images are combined Role of outer diameter of the endoscope:
to form a single probe like instrument. This
probe can be used in combination with different This is the most important factor that determines
sheaths. Using a small single sheath would create whether the scope can negotiate the narrow
a diagnostic endoscope. The gap existing between channels of salivary gland ductal system. These
the outer sheath and the optical system can be scopes are usually 1.5 mm in circumference. It is
used as irrigation channel. If a single large lumen this size that makes it easy for the scope to ne-
sheath / double lumen sheath is used then the gotiate salivary gland ductal system. Some of the
whole system transforms into a potent surgical semi rigid scopes made by Karl Storz have a slight
tool. bend near its tip, this feature helps the scope in
negotiating the branches of the ducts easier. This
The space inside the lumen can be used for intro- bend of course has its drawbacks. It reduces the
duction of various instruments. Major drawback effective diameter of the sheath there by making
of these modular systems is that sometimes air it difficult for insertion of straight surgical in-
may get entrapped struments via the portal. The intraductal position
into the channel blurring the field of vision. of these scopes can easily be ascertained by the
transillumination effect created over the skin. The
Advantages of modular endoscopes: shaft of the endoscope is provided with markings
which indicates the distance the scope has been
1. Economy – The optical system is the most introduced into the ductal system.
expensive part of any endoscopic system. In this
model the same system can be used for a variety Diameter of working channel:
of procedures.
The same optical system can be combined with This aspect is important inorder to perform
different sheaths there by creating a versatile tool. certain specialized therapeutic tasks using sialen-
2. Hygenic – Since the space between the sheath doscope. The working diameter has a direct effect
and the optical system is adequate on the stability of the instrument used in sialen-
for cleaning the system the scope can be cleaned doscopic therapeutics. Working channel diameter
easily there by ensuring hygiene. In comparison of 0.8 mm is a must for using instruments such as
the compact endoscopes have very thin irriga- forceps, balloons, or baskets. These instruments
442
1. Grasping forceps with serrated edges. These
forceps are useful in dilating the ducts and grasp-
ing and removing small stone fragments after
crushing the calculus.
2. Cup forceps with sharp edges. This forceps is
useful in crushing calculus and taking biopsy of
suspicious tissue.
These two forceps can easily be attached to an
universal handle. Ideally the handle which allows
rotation of the tip of the forceps is considered to
be advantageous.
Image showing toothed forceps used in sialendo-
scopic procedures
This is a mixture of forceps and basket. But its Solex soft lumen expanders:
use is highly limited. This instrument is slowly
finding its way out because of the propensity to The advantage of this instrument is that it is avail-
traumatize the ductal mucosa. This invariably able in different sizes. It contains an outer sheath
leads to ductal stenosis after the procedure which and an inner dilator. The advantage of this system
is a highly unwelcome complication. is that after dilatation the inner probe can be re-
444
moved leaving the outer sheath in the duct. ly used. They need a special syringe system for
inflation. Major advantage of this high pressure
Sialendoscope can easily be passed through this balloon is that they can easily be introduced
sheath, and calculi if any can be removed. Major via the sialendoscope port. Some of these high
advantage of leaving the outer sheath is that it pressure balloons have sharp cutting margins and
prevents damage to the ductal mucosa while the hence are very useful in fragmenting large sali-
calculus is being removed. vary ductal calculi.
Cytology Brushes:
Image showing solex soft lumen expander
These brushes were originally designed to take
Drills and micromotor system: biopsy from ducts of mammary glands. These
brushes can be used to harvest cells from inac-
Microdrills play a vital role in fragmenting the cessible areas of salivary glands there by facili-
salivary gland calculi there by facilitating easy tating tissue diagnosis. These brushes have been
atraumatic removal. These microburrs have a designed in such a way that they can easily pass
diameter of 0.38 – 0.4 mm. through the portal of a sialendoscope. These
brushes need to be handled with great care as
Balloons: they are very flimsy and can easily be damaged.
446
projects it on a digital monitor. It should be borne
Diagnostic sialendoscopy: in mind that a sphincter system is present near
the papilla of Wharton’s duct. Any damage to this
The advantage of this procedure is that it can be system may lead to unnecessary salivary drooling.
performed under local anesthesia. The mucosa of Papillotomy should be avoided in wharton’s duct.
oral cavity can be anesthetized by topical use of The same sphincter system of Stenson’s duct is
4% xylocaine. located posteriorly hence papillotomy of stenson’s
duct will not cause sphincter problems. Before
Additional infiltration anesthesia of the ductal introduction of the endoscope the zero position
area can be achieved by infiltration with 2% xylo- of the scope should be ascertained by focussing
caine with 1 in 10,00000 units adrenaline. on a letter. It is also prudent to orient onself to the
direction of the instrument channel of the sialen-
Step I: doscope before the actual introduction. When
performing sialendoscopy of submandibular
Dilatation of the papilla of salivary gland duct. salivary gland the sublingual salivary gland duct
This can be achieved by insertion of a sharp could be seen opening in to the anterior part of
conical dilator. Further dilatation is possible by wharton’s duct.
the introduction of a blunt conical dilator. If the
papilla is stenosed / narrowed due to persistent This opening usually lies 5 mm posterior to the
inflammation then papillotomy may have to be papilla. This is one of the reasons for avoiding
resorted to. papillotomy in wharton’s duct. While performing
sialendoscopy the lining mucosa of the ductal
Step II: system should be carefully examined. In a healthy
gland the ductal mucosa appears shiny and the
Creation of artificial cavity. As performed in underlying blood vessels can be clearly seen. In
abdominal laproscopic procedures an artifi- salivary glands affected by chronic sialadenitis the
cial cavity will have to be created to enable easy mucosal lining of the duct shows matted appear-
passage of sialendoscope. This cavity creation is ance with submucosal ecchymosis.
achieved by irrigation of isotonic saline via the
duct. The saline irrigated should be mixed with The presence of intraductal calculi if any should
4% xylocaine. The saline lubricates the duct of the be documented. In wharton’s duct the calculi are
gland facilitating easy passage of sialendoscope. usually seen at its bifurcation. This bifurcation is
The local anesthetic mixed with saline takes away present because of the presence of two portions
the pain and discomfort of insertion. (superficial and deep lobes of the submandibular
gland). In parotid duct calculi usually lie posteri-
Step III: or to its curvature.
Presence of sialoliths in the parenchyma of sali- Sialendoscopy can be effectively used in dilatation
vary glands can also be observed if present close / of salivary duct strictures.
adjacent to the ductal system.
Dilators rigid / balloon types can be used for the
Occult radiolucent calculi: same.
Role of sialendoscopy in the management of sali-
It should be borne in mind that nearly 70% of pa- vary gland calculi:
rotid gland calculi are radiolucent and quarter of
submandibular calculi are radiolucent. Diagnosis The aim in the management of sialolithiasis is to
of radiolucent calculi can be made only by ob- remove the calculus completely.
serving filling defects in a sialogram or by direct Sialendoscopy should be considered as one of the
visualization through sialendoscope. many management modalities available. Calculi
of submandibular gland measuring less than 4
Kink’s and strictures: mm can be removed
under sialendoscopic vision using basket. Simi-
Kink’s and strictures present in the salivary gland larly calculi measuring 3 mm and below can be
ductal system can be observed best in a sialo- removed using the same technique from parotid
gram. The same may be confirmed by performing duct. Any calculi measuring more than the above
sialendoscopy. mentioned size needs to be broken down into
small manageable bits using either crushing for-
Presence of pelvis like ductal formation of whar- ceps or extracorporeal / laser lithotripsy.
ton’s duct:
When the calculi has been shattered to smaller
This is one of the rare congenital anomalies that manageable bits they can be removed translu-
can be picked up while performing sialendoscopy. minally under endoscopic visualization. Normal
Instead of the routinely seen bifurcation / trifur- submandibular and parotid ducts measure 1.5
cation the main duct assumes a pelvis like forma- mm with the narrowest portion being 0.5 mm
tion thus leading to obstruction in the drainage of at the level of papilla. Hence the stone’s diameter
saliva. which can be handled by sialendoscopy should
not be larger than 150% of the diameter of the
Presence of intraductal foreign bodies like hair, anterior ducts.
448
Before attempting to remove salivary gland cal-
culi conservatively patients should been encour-
aged to take sialogogues like bubble gum and the
enlarged gland can be massaged in an attempt to
flush out the calculi from the duct. Only when
this conservative approach fails other invasive
modalities of treatment should be considered.
Difficult scenario:
However subglottic and supra glottic pressures During phonation two vibratory phases occur i.e.
also play a role in this transformation of aerody- open and closed phases. The open phase denotes
namic energy into sound energy. the phase during which the glottis is at least
partially open, while the closed phase denotes the
The requirements of normal phonation are as phase when the vocal folds completely occlude
follows: the glottic chink.
450
Oesophageal speech:
The open phase can be further divided into
opening and closing phases. The opening phase Patients after total laryngectomy acquire a certain
is defined as the phase during which the vocal degree of oesophageal speech. In fact all the other
folds move away from one another, while during alaryngeal speech modalities are compared with
the closing phase the vocal folds move together in that of oesophageal speech. It is the gold stan-
unison. dard for post laryngectomy speech rehabilitation
methods during 1970’s.
One important physiologic parameter which
must be noted during phonation is the mucosal In this method air is swallowed into the cervical
wave. The mucosal wave is an undulation which esophagus. This swallowed air is immediately
occur over the vocal fold mucosa. This wave expelled out causing vibrations of pharyngeal
travels in an infero superior direction. The speed mucosa. These mucosal
of mucosal wave ranges from 0.5 - 1 m/sec. The vibrations along with tongue in the oral cavity
symmetry of these mucosal waves must also be cause articulations. The exact vibrating portion
taken into consideration while studying the phys- in these patients is the pharyngo esophageal
iology of voice production. Any mild asymmetry segment. This segment is made up of muscula-
between the two vocal folds must be considered ture and mucosa of lower cervical area (C5 – C7
as pathological. segments).
The function of vocal folds is to produce sound This method is very difficult to learn and only 20
varying in intensity and pitch. This sound is then % of patients succeed in this endeavor. Patients
modified by various resonating chambers present with oesophageal speech speak in short bursts, as
above and below the larynx and are converted the bellow
into words by the articulating action of the phar- effect of the lungs are not utilized in speech gen-
ynx, tongue, palate, teeth and lips. eration. The vibrations of muscles and mucosa of
cervical esophagus and hypopharynx are respon-
The consonants of speech can be associated with sible for speech production. Oral cavity plays
particular anatomical sites responsible for their an important role in generation of oesophageal
generation i.e. ‘p’ and ‘b’ are labials, ’t’ and ’d’ are speech.
dentals and ‘m’ and ‘n’ are nasals.
Air from the oral cavity is swallowed into the cer-
Methods of alaryngeal speech: vical oesophagus before speech isgenerated. There
are two methods by which air can be pumped
There are 3 methods of alaryngeal speech. They into the cervical oesophagus. They are:
include:
Injection method: In this method the person
1. Oesophageal speech builds up enough positive pressure in the oral
2. Electrolarynx cavity forcing air into the cervical oesophagus.
3. Tracheo oesophageal puncture This is achieved by elevating the tongue against
the palate. Air can also be injected into the cer-
452
Image of Flow chart showing various voice restoration options following laryngectomy
1. Neoglottic reconstruction
2. Shunt techniques
Neoglottic reconstruction:
Shunt technique:
454
Image showing he advantages of electrolarynx
This procedure for restoration of speech in pa- Voice prosthesis is actually a one way valve made
tients who have undergone total laryngectomy of medical grade silicon. This is a barrel shaped
was first introduced by Blom and Singer in 1979. device with two flanges. One flange enters the oe-
In addition to the procedure of tracheo oesopha- sophagus while the other one rests in the trachea.
geal puncture Blom – Singer developed a silicone It actually fits snuggly into the tracheo-oesopha-
one way slit valve which can be inserted into the geal puncture wound. This prosthesis is provided
puncture wound. This valve formed a one way with a unidirectional valve at its oesophageal
conduit for air into the oesophagus and also pre- end. Indwelling prosthesis usually have more
vented leakage of oesophageal contents into the larger and rigid flanges when compared to that of
456
non-indwelling ones. Non-indwelling prosthesis
has a safety medallion attached to the main struc-
ture to prevent accidental aspiration.
458
Image showing disadvantages of TEP
460
Image showing contraindications for TEP
462
thesis acted as a one way valve allowing air to pass
from trachea into the oesophagus, and prevent- Blom-singer dual valve prosthesis:
ed aspiration into the trachea. This prosthesis is
shaped like a duck bill. The duck bill end of the This prosthesis has two valves which ensures
prosthesis should reach the oesophagus, while there is absolutely no risk of aspiration, while
the opposite end shaped like a holed button rests air is allowed to flow from the trachea into the
snugly against the tracheostome. This is actually oesophagus. This prosthesis is suitable in whom
an indwelling prosthesis which can be safely left primary voice prosthesis has failed due to leak
in place for at least 3-4 months without the need from oesophagus into the trachea.
for cleaning.
This prosthesis is available in varying lengths This is an indwelling low air flow resistance pros-
(6mm – 28mm). thesis.
The advantage of this prosthesis is the extended
Classical Blom-Singer prosthesis is indwelling life time. It can last anywhere between 1-2 years
one. Since it needs higher pressure to open up it if properly used. Insertion and maintenance of
can cause problems in some patients. Currently this prosthesis is also pretty simple and straight
low pressure Blom-singer prosthesis has been forward.
introduced. This is also made of medical grade
silicone with a one way flapper valve replacing the
duck bill. Only difference being the low pressure
Blom-singer prosthesis is non-indwelling type
and can be easily maintained by the patient.
Secondary TEP:
In dwelling Non Indwelling Yanker’s suction is introduced into the oral cavity
Can be left in situ for Must be removed can of the patient. It is pushed inside till it hitches
6 months cleaned every 3 /4 against the posterior wall of the tracheostome at
days 12 o clock position.
Requires specialist to Patient can do it
do the job themselves 2% xylocaine with 1 in 100,000 adrenaline is
Less maintenance Periodical mainte- injected via the tracheostome in the exact area
nance needed where the tip of Yanker’s suction hitches against.
Incision is made exactly in the area where the tip
Tracheostoma 2 cms Tracheostoma more
of Yanker’s suction hitches at the 12 0 clock posi-
than 2 cms needed
tion of tracheostome.
464
Image showing end tracheostome after removal of tracheostomy tube
After ensuring that the TEP is fairly widened, the It is always better to perform transnasal oesoph-
Blom-singer Prosthesis is introduced and an- ageal insufflation test before TEP insertion. This
chored with silk around the neck. test will assess the response of pharyngeal con-
strictor muscle to
Problems caused due to TEP insertion: oesophageal distension in these patients.
466
Image showing the incision being widened using a curved artery forceps
Speech language pathologist should be actively The puncture site is ideally located at 12 0 clock
involved in rehabilitation of patients following position in relation to the tracheostome. It is
insertion of TEP prosthesis. The rehabilitation placed about 1 – 1.5 cms from the tracheocutane-
process starts while the patient is still hospitalized ous junction 14. If located superior to the stomal
and is usually continued during the first week of rim patient will find it difficult to occlude the
surgery. During this period the speech and lan- stoma in order to produce speech. Similarly if the
guage pathologist should assess the tracheostome stoma is located deep inside the trachea then in-
and site of TEP. Focus should be directed to iden- sertion of the prosthesis becomes rather difficult.
tify leaks from inside or around the prosthesis.
During this initial stage patient can be encour- Size of the puncture:
468
quality voice. If leak is persistent then the shaft
This aspect is important for fluent speech. The of the prosthesis can be plugged using q tip while
size of the stoma should at least be 2 cms for pro- swallowing food.
duction of fluent speech. If the size of the stoma
is smaller than 2 cms it is prudent to enlarge it
appropriately to benefit the patient. Management of leaks through prosthesis:
Management of leak:
Cause Solution
TEP location Remove TEP allow
it to close and then
re-puncture
Unnecessary dilata- Defer dilatation and
tion during routine perform it only if it is
placement absolutely needed
Thin tracheo-oesoph- Select customized
ageal wall 6mm / less prosthesis
Prosthesis of incor- Choose the correct
rect length and size sized prosthesis
470
Submandibular salivary gland excision the posterior belly and the XII nerve runs imme-
diately deep to the digastric tendon.
Indication:
Mylohyoid muscle:
1. Sialolithiasis
2. Chronic sialadenitis This is a flat muscle attached to the mylohyoid
3. Benign tumors involving submandibular sali- line on the inner aspect of the mandible, the body
vary gland of the hyoid bone, and by a midline raphe to the
4. Malignant tumors involving submandibular opposite muscle. It is a key structure when excis-
salivary gland ing the submandibular gland, as it forms the floor
of the mouth, and separates the cervical form of
Surgical anatomy: the oral part of the submandibular gland. One
important aspect for the surgeon to remember is
The submandibular gland has two components: that there are no important neurovascular struc-
1. Oral - Above the mylohyoid muscle tures superficial to the mylohyoid muscle. The
2. Cervical - Below the mylohyoid muscle. Con- lingual nerve and the XII nerve are deep to the
nected to the oral component by a tail that passes muscle.
around the posterior border of mylohyoid muscle.
The mylohyoid muscle which forms the dia- Marginal mandibular nerve:
phragm of the mouth separates the oral compo-
nent from the cervical component. This branch of the facial nerve which supplies the
depressor anguli oris runs within the investing
Major portion of the submandibular gland is situ- layers of deep cervical fascia overlying the gland
ated mainly in the submandibular triangle (Level and may loop up to 3 cms below the ramus of the
1b) of the neck. The oral component extends mandible.
some distance along the submandibular duct im-
mediately deep to the mucosa of the floor of the It is composed of 4 parallel running branches.
mouth. The duct opens close to the midline in the It crosses over the facial artery and vein before
anterior floor of the mouth. ascending to innervate the depressor anguli oris
(the muscle of lower lip). In order to protect this
The cervical portion of the gland is immediately nerve, one should incise skin and platysma at
deep to the platysma, and is encapsulated by the least 3 cms below the mandible and incise the
investing layer of deep cervical fascia. facial covering of the submandibular gland just
above the hyoid bone and do a subcapsular resec-
Digastric muscle: tion of the gland.
Nerve to mylohyoid:
Anesthesia:
This is a branch of the third division of the tri-
geminal nerve and it innervates the mylohyoid General anesthesia with orotracheal intubation
and anterior belly of diagastric. It is generally with tube secured to contralateral corner of
not looked for or preserved at surgery. But when mouth.
diathermy is used to mobilize the gland off the
mylohyoid muscle, contractions of the mylohyoid Position:
and anterior belly of digastric is usually noted due
to stimulation of this nerve. Patient is supine with head end of the table ele-
vated to reduce bleeding with face turned to the
Facial artery: opposite side.
472
Image showing anatomy of submandibular salivary gland
474
wharton’s duct.
After ligation of the facial artery and vein superi-
orly, the submandibular gland is retracted inferi-
orly to identify the submandibular ganglion that
is then divided to free the lingual nerve, it should
be ensured that the nerve should not be included
in the tie.
476
bilities in one device.
Kashima surgery for bilateral abductor paraly-
sis of vocal cords using coblation Incision is made 1 mm in front of the vocal
process of arytenoid and a 3.5-4 mm C-shaped
Introduction: portion of the posterior 1/3 of the vocal cord is
ablated from the free border of the membranous
Bilateral Vocal Fold Paralysis is a surgical emer- cord, extending 4 mm laterally over the ventric-
gency which has to be promptly addressed and ular band. This created about 6-7 mm transverse
airway secured, voice preservation taking a back- opening at the posterior glottis. Vocal process
seat. is ideally not exposed. Anterior 2/3 of the vocal
fold is left undisturbed and hence phonation and
In this context two terms need to be explained sphincteric function of larynx is maintained.
-BVFI & BVFP. Bilateral Vocal Fold Immobil-
ity (BVFI) is a broad term which encompasses
all forms of reduced or absent movement of the
vocal folds; whereas Bilateral Vocal Fold Paralysis
refers to the Neurological causes of BVFI and spe-
cifically refers to the reduced or absent function
of the Vagus nerve or its distal branch, the Recur-
rent Laryngeal Nerve.
Surgical Procedure:
478
Surgery Toxins
Gout
Mechanical causes:
Ankylosing spondylitis
Acute complications of intubation include aryte-
noid dislocation, anterior dislocation of thyroid Reiter syndrome
cartilage relative to cricoid causing recurrent
laryngeal nerve injury. SLE
Evaluation:
480
Vocal fold surgery
482
Micro flap technique:
484
Advantages of Gor-Tex:
1. It is malleable
Instead of silastic block other material can be 4. This procedure is reversible and has very few
used to medialize the vocal cord. These material complications
include:
5. Creates less oedema when compared to that of
1. Fat silastic and hence over correction is not possible
486
Image showing ala of thyroid cartilage exposed
after retracting the overlying strap muscles Image showing Gortex being introduced through
the cartilage window
Image showing cartilage window created Image showing cartilage window closed using
interrupted absorbable sutures
488
Autologous fat
Carboxymethylcellulose and glycerin water based
Autologous fascia gel:
General contraindications for injection laryngo- 2. Other approaches that could be considered:
plasty:
Percutaneous injection through cricothyroid
1. Acute laryngeal inflammation membrane.
Dysphagia
490
Technique:
After the skin becomes numb the nasopharyn-
Transcutaneous injection laryngoplasty aims to goscope is passed transnasally. Nasal mucosa
medialize a patient’s vocal cord. The needle of should be anesthetized using 4% xylocaine
attached to the syringe is placed through the thy- soaked cotton pledgets inserted into the nasal
rohyoid membrane, thyroid cartilage or through cavity prior to insertion of nasopharyngoscope.
the cricothyroid membrane. The surgeon passes the needle with the attached
syringe through the skin via any of the three ap-
Before actually begining the injection process the proaches which include:
following structures should be outlined in the
neck: Transthyroyoid membrane approach - The thy-
rohyoid membrane lies between the hyoid bone
Hyoid bone superiorly and the thyroid cartilage inferiorly. In
this approach, the injectable needle is passed in
Thyroid cartilage an inferior direction through the midline thyro-
hyoid membrane and directed laterally into the
Cricoid cartilage vocal fold.
All these structures are marked over the skin us- The skin superior to and overlying the thyroid
ing skin marker. Skin area has to be anesthetized notch is anesthetized with 1% xylocaine. A
as per the approach using xylocaine 2% with 1 in syringe filled with augmentation material with
100,000 units adrenaline. a 25 gauge needle is passed superior to the thy-
roid notch through the skin, subcutaneous tissue
and pre-epiglottic space, superior to the vocal
folds into the airway. Once the needle enters the
airway, it can be visualized with the nasopharyn-
goscope and directed laterally into the vocal fold.
The augmentation material is placed within the
paraglottic space under direct visualization.
492
been noted in cadaver experiments that too in on the screen of the monitor.
female larynges.
A special injection needle (Merz Aesthetics) is
5. Approximately 0.6-0.8 ml of the material is used. The needle is a long curved one and is at-
needed to medialize a male vocal cord and 0.4 ml tached to the syringe. The length of the needle is
is needed for a female vocal cord. Slight over cor- such that it can be introduced via the oral cavity
rection should be performed to account for some to reach the superior surface of the vocal folds.
resorption of material.
Complications:
494
Image showing strip usually about 3 mm wide
removed and the edges sutured after overlap.
Nonabsorbent sutures need to be used.
Type 4 thyroplasty:
Indications:
Androphonia
Gender dysphonia
Procedure:
496
Image showing thyroid cartilage skeletonized
498
Equipment used in otolaryngology surgery
60-99 degrees centigrade - dehydration occurs Bipolar - In this mode, the two electrodes are
(tissue coagulation) found on the instrument itself. The bipolar ar-
500
rangement negates the need for dispersive elec- does the corresponding tissue effect. Electrosur-
trodes, instead a pair of similar sized electrodes gical generators provide delivery in two types of
are used in tandem. The current is then passed modes: Continuous and interrupted. The contin-
between the electrodes. uous mode of current output is often referred to
as cut mode and delivers electrosurgical energy as
Bipolar is commonly used in surgery involv- continuous sinusoidal waveform. The interrupt-
ing digits, in patients with pacemakers to avoid ed mode of current delivery is referred to as the
electrical interference with the pacemaker and in coagulation mode.
microsurgery to catch bleeders.
Modern appliances offer a wide variety of electri-
cal waveforms. In addition to the pure cut mode,
Cutting / coagulation: there are often blended modes that modify the
degree of current interruption to achieve varying
There are two main settings of diathermy (cutting degrees of cutting with hemostasis.
and coagulation).
The size and geometry of the electrodes delivering
Cutting uses a continuous wave form with a low the energy play an important role in achieving the
voltage. In the cutting mode, the electrode reach- desired effect. The smaller the contact area of the
es a high enough power to vaporise the water electrode, the higher the potential current con-
content. Thus in this mode, it is able to perform centration that can be applied to the tissue. The
a clean cut but it is less efficient at coagulating. In most important factor in achieving the desired
the cutting mode the focus of heat is more at the surgical effect with electrosurgical unit lies in the
surgical site, using sparks being the more focused surgeon’s manipulation of the electrode.
way to distribute heat. In the cutting mode, the
tip of the electrode is held slightly away from the
tissue.
Modern electrosurgical generators offer a wide Image showing the cautery arrangement inside
variety of electrical waveforms. They are capable the operation theatre
of modulating signals depending on the mode
setting. As the output wave forms change, so
Complications:
502
instrument with several important features which
Operating Microscope include:
Single lens magnifiers - Used convex lenses for 7. Stereopsis should provide the third dimension
magnifying with a fixed magnification and a very of the field of view. This really increases the safety
short working distance. Major disadvantage of of the surgical process
this system happens to be the fixed magnification
level and a very short working distance. 8. Multiple optical ports like viewer port, camera
port should be available
Telescopic system - This system has the advantage
of had better working distance. Keeler Galilean Technical aspects:
system was the first telescopic system to be intro-
duced in 1952 and was provided with a two times Operating microscope can be divided into a
magnification at 25 cm distance. In addition microscope body, light source and a supporting
to this feature, a set of five different telescopes, structure. Each of these components are vital for
which could separately be fixed on a spectacle the performance of the microscope. In addition
frame using screws provided the surgeon with the to these three basic conventional parts, modern
choice of magnification from 1.75 - 9 times with a microscopes have adopted advanced technologies
working distance ranging from 34 to 16.5 cm. to facilitate visualization and surgical navigation.
Based on the configuration there are four types of 300 mm lenses - Used in nasal surgeries
surgical microscopes:
400 mm lenses - Used in laryngeal surgeries
Microscope on casters
The same microscope can be utilized for ear nose
Wall mounted microscopes and throat surgeries by simply changing the ob-
jective lenses.
Table top microscopes
Magnification:
Ceiling mounted microscopes
Surgeons from many fields have recognized the
The on caster stand mounted microscopes are usefulness of magnification. The total magnifica-
very popular because of its mobility. It should be tion of the surgical microscope is determined by
stressed that ceiling mount / wall mount micro- all the four optical components in the microscope
scopes help in efficient space management. which include:
The support structure of a modern operating Focal length of the objective lens
microscope has precision motorized mechanics
so that the microscope can be balanced easily and Zoom value
adjusted flexibly to the exact position. The funda-
mental task of the support structure is to keep the Focal length of the binocular tube
microscope stable.
504
Magnifying power of eyepieces
Xenon lamp emits light with a broad spectrum
Magnification power of modern microscopes from ultraviolet to infrared. The spectrum is
usually varies form 4X to 40X, and is usually relatively smooth in the visible range, but it has
selected through a manual or motorized magni- some spikes in the near-infrared range. Xenon
fication changer. Human eyes have an inherent light has a color temperature of 4000-6000 K,
resolution of 0.2 mm but with 20X magnification which is similar to sunlight. Therefore, the bright
it can be increased to 0.1 mm. This adds to the white light is able to offer a naturally colored view
confidence of the surgeon while working in criti- of the anatomy. Halogen lamp also covers a wide
cal areas. and continuous spectrum including visible and
Near infrared light. It has a slightly lower color
Light source: temperature (3200-5000 K) which means that the
light does not look as “white” as xenon light.
Old generation microscopes were provided with
traditional incandescent bulbs which had their Disadvantage of halogen and xenon lamps is that
own disadvantages which included limitations they emit heat, to avoid optics from being heated
in the brightness levels and color reproduction. up the light source (halogen/xenon) are placed
Currently there are three main types of light away from the optics.
sources:
Illumination arrangement:
Xenon lamp
The tissue surface that is viewed under a surgical
Halogen lamp microscope is usually wet and highly reflective.
The light that comes from an angle can easily be
LED lamp reflected away and cause a dark view. Coaxial
illumination is the solution to this situation. This
Among these three LED provides illumination illumination matches the optical axes of illumi-
in the visible wavelength with good brightness, nation and visualization (lens). Coaxial illumi-
stability, longer life and with less power consump- nation reduces the diameter of the illuminated
tion, less heat. This lamp is hence ideal for oto- area and it can be directed into narrow and deep
laryngologists and ophthalmologists. LED lamps cavities. This feature is helpful for otolaryngolog-
has the following disadvantages too: ical surgery.
The higher color temperature and narrower The light path for coaxial illumination for oto-
wavelength range makes the light not as close to laryngological surgeries usually forms a small
sunlight. angle with the observation axis in the range of 6
degrees. This is called as the small angle of illu-
Its spectrum is insufficient for fluorescence guid- mination where in illumination is concentrated
ed applications. and evenly distributed. With the small angle of
illumination the shadow appears at the edge of
It is difficult to replace. the viewing field and does not disturb the vision
506
Draping the microscope:
Visualization system:
Microscope should be draped during the process
of surgery. These drapes helps in minimizing Clear and bright visualization of the surgical site
wound infections and maintains the sterile area. is the ultimate goal of using an operating mi-
These drapes are very thin, transparent and is croscope. In addition to the good image quality
made out of heat resistant plastic film. It should provided by high precision optics and sufficient
cover the entire microscope and should be avail- illumination, the steroscopic view offers depth
able in sterile packaging which can be opened information is another non negligible feature a
prior to surgery. Features of the microscope microscope should possess.
drapes include:
Microscope users can observe the surgical site
1. Should have adequate number of ocular pock- in various ways. All microscopes have one main
ets observation port and one rear / lateral port for
co-viewers and one for attachment of camera /
2. It should not reduce the working distance imaging systems. All these optical ports offer an
almost identical field of vision.
3. It should not obstruct the surgeon’s view
Stereopsis:
4. Drapes should be glare free. As light passes
through the objective lens and illuminates the This is very important key feature of binocular
surgical field, some of the light would be reflected surgical microscopes. In monocular micro-
by the lens cover on the drape. This can cause scopes depth cues lie in perspective projection,
chromatic and spherical aberrations. Removing occlusion size, shading and motion parallax, the
the cover would cause contamination of surgical stereoscopic depth is based on minor disparities
instruments. A dome shaped lens cover can re- between two images presented to two eyes. The
duce the reflection without compromising magni- light coming out of the objective lens is divided
fication. into two parts and forms two slightly different
images into two channels. In surgery, especially
Control: when working with magnification, perspective,
and size cues may be lost, therefore the stereopsis
Surgical microscopes can be controlled in differ- brought by binocular is essential to provide a 3 D
ent ways. Ideally foot control is preferred because impression of the surgical field. An optical design
the surgeon would like to have both hands free that enhances stereo visualization for operating
during the entire process of surgery. Foot switch microscopes is the FusionOptics technology. This
and mouth switches are provided in different sets two separate beam paths in the optical head,
microscopes for this purpose. Currently eye con- providing the depth of field and high resolution
trolled microscopes are the trend. It uses IR-LED respectively. The two paths are then merged in
to illuminate the surgeon’s eye and a large CCD the observers brain into a single, optical spatial
sensor is used to detect the reflected infrared light image. Because of this combination of depth and
from the surgeon’s eye movement tracking. resolution, the interruptions for refocusing can be
508
Lasers mirror as the laser beam.
The optical cavity containing the lasing medium Tissue interactions with lasers:
has a 100% reflective mirror at one end and a
semi reflective mirror at the other end. The pho- Laser light falling on tissues may be reflected,
tons travelling along the axis of the mirrors are scattered, transmitted or absorbed. Out of all
reflected and thus continue travelling within the these interactions only absorbed light causes a
optical cavity and simulating the release of more tissue reaction.
photons. Photons not travelling along the axis of
the mirrors are not repeatedly reflected and thus Reflection:
are not amplified. This process of reflection pro-
duces a temporally and spatially coherent beam Part or whole of laser light is reflected back
of light which escapes via the semi-reflective
Scatter: Absorption:
Laser energy scatters in the tissues and its pen- Laser energy is absorbed by the tissue. It is exactly
etration deep into the tissues becomes limited. this absorbed energy that produces the effect on
Shorter the wavelength of laser more of the ener- the tissue. The main substance that absorbs the
gy is scattered. laser is called the primary chromophore. Ab-
sorption produces mainly kinetic excitation of
Transmission: the absorbing molecules. This kinetic excitation
produces thermal effects ranging from reversible
The light is transmitted through the tissue with- hyperthermia through enzyme deactivation, pro-
out causing any effect on tissues through which tein denaturation, and coagulation to dehydra-
it passed. Argon laser has been used to coagulate tion, vaporization and carbonization.
retinal vessels without any damage to cornea, lens
or the vitreous. The effect of laser on tissue depends on the
absorbed energy. At a temperature of 60 degrees
centigrade, there is protein denaturation, but
tissues can recover from here. At 80 degrees cen-
510
tigrade there is degradation of collagen tissue and Photochemical:
at 100 degrees centigrade, cells and their pericel-
lular water convert into heat that causes tissue ab- Ultraviolet lasers with wavelength of 248 and 312
lation. Lasers can hence be used to cut, coagulate nm can ionize DNA and RNA respectively. They
blood vessels or vaporize the tissue. When a burn could even be carcinogenic. This effect of specific
is caused by a laser beam there is some degree of lasers (argon) has been used in photodynamic
collateral damage. therapy to selectively destroy cancerous tissue.
It can be used to break stones and is used in lith- Lasers that can be transmitted through optical
otripsy. fibers include:
4. Spot size: This is actually the area exposed to Minimal post op pain
the laser beam. Spot size is the minimum at focal
length. Focused beam is used for cutting and de- Minimal tissue oedema
focussed beam is used for coagulation / ablation
of tissues. Disadvantages:
6. Exposure to laser: This value is the power den- Safety precautions need to be taken
sity multiplied by duration of exposure in seconds
and is measured in joules/ cubic cm. Types of lasers used in otolaryngology:
512
Argon laser:
KTP lasers can be used on soft tissue ablation
This lies in the visible spectrum. Does not eed (tonsillectomy). This will depend on their capac-
pointing ray. It is absorbed by hemoglobin. Hence ity for small spot size delivery. KTP lasers can
it is used to treat portwine stain, hemaingioma be delivered by quartz fibers. The unpredictable
and telengiectasis. When focused to a small point effects of argon laser on soft tissue limit its appli-
it can vaporize the target tissue. This laser is used cation in the airway.
to create a hole in the foot plate of stapes. It needs
a drop of blood to be placed over the foot plate Nd:YAG laser:
for this effect to occur.
This laser has a wavelength of 1064 nm and lies in
Because of the excellent absorption of the argon the infrared zone. It is in the invisible range and
laser by hemoglobin, the major clinical applica- requires a separate aiming beam of visible light to
tion has been ophthalmology and dermatology. focus. It can pass through clear fluids and is also
This laser has been useful for coagulation of reti- absorbed by pigmented tissue as the case may in
nal blood vessels in instances of diabetic retinop- eye and urinary bladder. In otolaryngology it has
athy and for the treatment of port-wine stain. been used to debulk tracheobronchial and esoph-
ageal lesions for palliation.
KTP laser:
It is poorly absorbed by water, and hence pene-
This laser also lies in the visible spectrum. It has a trates tissue deeply. The energy is not dissipated
wavelength of 532 nm. These waves are absorbed at the surface, as is the case with carbondioxide /
by hemoglobin and can be delivered via optical KTP 532 and argon lasers. It scatters within the
fibers. This laser is also used ins tapes surgery, en- tissue depending on the degree of tissue pigmen-
doscopic sinus surgery to remove polypi, inverted tation for absorption.
papilloma and vascular lesions.
The Nd:YAG laser can be transmitted through
KTP and argon lasers have similar characteristics. commonly available flexible quartz fibers making
Both these lasers operate in the visible spectrum it possible to be used in the tracheobronchial tree.
at the wavelength of 532 and 518 respectively. Because the laser beam diverges approximately 10
These lasers can be delivered through flexible degrees as it leaves the fiber, the closer the fiber to
fibers. Both these lasers are well absorbed by the tissue the smaller is the spot size. Care should
pigmented tissue and hemoglobin and are poorly be taken to apply the laser energy in brief expo-
absorbed by pale tissue thus making them good sures of 1 second or less at a power setting below
coagulators and fairly good ablators of pigmented 50 Watts. Continuous application of the laser at
tissue. Compared with the Nd:YAG laser, howev- high power settings could result in “popcorn” ef-
er, this effect on tissue is superficial. Spot sizes of fect which is an explosion of the tissue caused by
0.15 mm can be achieved depending on the optics high energy below the tissue surface that creates
used that create high power densities capable an expanding cavity.
of cutting and ablating tissue independent of its
wavelength absorption. The Nd:YAG laser wavelength has little visible ef-
Contact - In this mode it is good for cutting soft Advancements in laser technology and microma-
tissue and even thin bone. It is however not nipulator optics have enable the diameter of the
adequate for hemostasis. When used in contact carbondioxide laser spot to be reduced when used
mode, the Nd:YAG laser energy concentrates at with a 400 mm focal length. The focal length of
the tip of the fiber and causes limited vaporiza- this laser was reduced from 2 mm in the early
tion of tissue and little damage to the surrounding 1970s to 0.8 mm in the early 80s and to 0.3 mm in
tissue. This mode is good for coagulating blood 1987. Necessary laser wattage has been reduced
vessels less than 1 mm in diameter; its effect on from 10 to 2 watts because of the higher beam
soft tissue is similar to that of carbondioxide laser. concentration or power density.
514
be worn to prevent retinal damage. Patient’s eye is then excised using either microscissors or laser.
should be protected by double layer of saline Development of microspot, micromanipulator
soaked cotton eye pads. All exposed areas of face facilitated tissue excision with precise cutting and
are covered by saline soaked pads. minimal damage to the surrounding mucosa and
underlying vocalis muscle. In addition since the
Endotracheal tubes: carbondioxide laser is used in a no touch mode it
permits unobstructed observation of the surgical
Wave specific tubes are available. Rubber tubes field so as to note the effect of laser on the tissue
are better than PVC as they are more resistant to layer by layer. Carbondioxide laser has been used
laser hits. PVC tubes when hit by laser can gener- to remove benign laryngeal lesions and is espe-
ate toxic fumes. These endotracheal tubes should cially effective for vascular polyps, large sessile
be covered by reflective aluminium foils. The nodules and cysts and for the evacuation of pol-
cuff of the endotracheal tube should be inflated ypoid myxomatous changes.
with blue dye mixed saline and covered with wet
cottonoids. In case of accidental hit by laser blue The key to successful laryngoscopic excision is
color effusion will warn the surgeon. good exposure. Anterior commissure laryn-
goscope is preferred to expose the vocal cords.
Anesthetic gases: Kleinsasser laryngoscope which is suspension
based and can be anchored to the chest of the
Non inflammable gases are used. Halothane / patient can be used. Main advantage of suspen-
enflurane are preferred to nitrous oxide. Concen- sion laryngoscope is that when it is used both the
tration of oxygen should not exceed 40%. hands of the surgeon are free.
516
The arytenoid to be resected should be well
exposed, as should the posterior commissure
and at least half of the other arytenoid cartilage.
The carbondioxide laser is coupled to an oper-
ating microscope with a 400 nm objective lens.
The laser is et at pulse duration of 0.1 second in
repeat intermittent mode at a power of 10W and
a focused spot size of 0.8 mm. The laser pow-
er can be lowered accordingly when a smaller
spot impact is used. The mucosa overlying the
arytenoid cartilage is vaporized, exposing the
underlying cartilage. The corniculate cartilage
and apex of the arytenoid are vaporized using the
laser in continuous mode. The upper body of the
arytenoid cartilage is vaporized after ablating the
perichondrium that overlies it, using the laser in
the continuous mode at a power setting of 15 W.
The lower body of arytenoid cartilage is vapor-
ized working laterally to medially with the laser
Image showing KTP contact laser probe in action set at 0.1 second in intermittent pulses at a power
setting of 10 W. The vocal and muscular process-
es are vaporized using the same laser settings.
The mucosa is cut 2-3 mm in front of the vocal
process so as to create a triangular posterior air-
way. A small area lateral to the vocalis muscle is
vaporized to induce scarring and promote further
lateralization during the healing process.
518
Use of carbondioxide lasers in management of
choanal atresia has many advantages. The trans-
nasal approach using laser ablation has proved
useful. This coupled with the use of operating
microscope with 300 mm objective lens really
provides the surgeon with an excellent view of the
surgical field. Because of the hemostatic effects
of laser, the post operative oedema is minimal or
absent.
Role of lasers in otology is rather controversial In the oral cavity laser is mainly sued as a he-
but currently stapedectomies are performed using mostatic cutting knife and carbondioxide laser
laser. KTP laser is used for this purpose. In order is ideal in these situations. It can be used with a
to vaporize the stapes foot plate, the laser with a handpiece or with a micromanipulator to delin-
spot size of 50-100 micro meter is used, pulse du- eate and resect small tumors of the tongue, floor
ration of 10 msec, and a power of 0.7 W is ideal. of the mouth, and mucosa of the cheek. The
Laser stapedotomy has some unique advantages advantages of carbondioxide laser include good
where in the fracturing or mobilizing the foot hemostasis, precise cutting and when coupled
plate is less when the posterior crus is vaporized with operating microscope surgery becomes
before removing suprastructures thus decreasing very safe. The advantages of microscope is that it
the risk of a floating foot plate. Stapedotomy can permits magnification with better appreciation of
also be performed easily with minimal trauma the laser effects on the tissue. Microscopic vision
and without vibration. is preferred for stationary targets like the floor of
the mouth, palate, immobile tongue and retromo-
The argon, carbondioxide and KTP lasers have lar area. Handpiece is preferred for mobile areas.
been found to be useful in ossicular surgery. The The surgical defect is not sutured or grafted but is
carbondioxide laser is easy to use because of its left to heal by second intention.
articulating arm delivery system that can be con-
nected to the operating microscope and because The application of laser technology to the endo-
of its small spot size (0.2-0.3 mm at a focal length scopic treatment of patients with tracheobron-
of 250 mm). The surgeon can operate using a chial mass lesions began with the use of carbon-
no-touch technique with good visualization and dioxide laser to ablate tumors such as respiratory
precise ablation of the ossicles. papillomas. With the introduction of Nd:YAG
lasers which has special hemostatic qualities
The argon and KTP laser beams are usually de- enhanced the safety of laser procedures in the
livered through a flexible fibre that is held in the tracheobranchial tree. Laser therapy can be used
hand like middle ear instrument. repeatedly for the palliation of malignant tra-
cheobranchial obstruction. The hypervascularity
The excellent absorption by water of the carbon- of many malignant endobronchial neoplasms
dioxide laser energy is a good protective measure are best treated with Nd:YAG laser because of its
520
coagulation properties.
522
Coblation technology in Otolaryngology
Initially coblation technology was used in ar-
Introduction: throscopic surgeries immensely benefiting in-
jured athletes. Coblation is non-thermal volumet-
The technology of using plasma to ablate biolog- ric tissue removal through molecular
ical tissue was first described by Woloszko and dissociation. This action is more or less similar
Gilbride. By their pioneering work in this field to that of Excimer lasers. This technology uses
they proved that radio frequency current could be the principle that when electric current is passed
passed through local regions of the body without through a conducting fluid, a charged layer of
discharge taking place. particles known as the plasma is released. These
charged particles has a tendency to accelerate
Radio frequency technology for medical use (for through plasma, and gains energy to break the
cutting, coagulation and tissue dessication) was molecular bonds within the cells. This ultimately
popularized by Cushing and Bovie. Cushing an causes disintegration of cells molecule by mole-
eminent neurosurgeon found this technology ex- cule causing volumetric reduction of tissue.
cellent for his neurosurgical procedures. First use
of this technology inside the operating room took Medical effects of plasma has spurred a evolu-
place on October 1st 1926 at Peter Bent Brigham tion of new science “Plasma Medicine”. It is now
Hospital in Boston, Massachusetts. It was Dr evidently clear that Plasma not only has physical
Cushing who removed a troublesome intracranial effects (cutting and coagulation) on the tissues
tumor using this equipment. but also other beneficial therapeutic effects too.
Plasma not only coagulates blood vessels but also
The term coblation is derived from “Controlled decontaminates surgical wound thereby facilitat-
ablation”. This procedure involves non-heat driv- ing better wound healing. Therapeutic application
en process of soft tissue dissolution using bipolar of plasma assumes that plasma discharges are
radio-frequency energy under a conductive medi- ignited at atmospheric pressure.
um like normal saline. When current from radio
frequency probe pass through saline medium it Plasma Medicine:
breaks saline into sodium and chloride ions.
This field of medicine can be subdivided into:
These highly energized ions form a plasma field 1. Plasma assisted modification of biorelevant
which is sufficiently strong to break organic surfaces
molecular bonds within soft tissue causing its 2. Plasma based decontamination and steriliza-
dissolution. Coblation (Controlled ablation) was tion
first discovered by Hira V. Thapliyal and Philip E. 3. Direct therapeutic application
Eggers. This was actually a fortuitous discovery in
their quest for unblocking coronary arteries using Plasma assisted modification of biorelevant sur-
electrosurgical energy. In order to market this faces:
emerging technology these two started an upstart This technique is used to optimize the biofunc-
company ArthroCare. Coblation wands were ex- tionality of implants, or to qualify polymer sur-
hibited in arthroscopy trade show during 1996. faces for cell culturing and tissue engineering.
Not all surgical instruments can be effectively Types of cold atmospheric Plasma (CAP):
sterilized using currently available technologies. CAP’s basically are of 3 types:
This is due to the fact that plastics cannot be
effectively be sterilized by conventional means as 1. Direct Plasma - It has a single needle electrode
it could get degraded on exposure to steam and which generates plasma source. It is useful in
heat. Plasma discharges have been found to be re- managing skin lesions.
ally useful in this scenario because of its low tem- 2. Indirect Plasma is generated between two
perature action. The nature of plasma actions on electrodes and is transported to the area of appli-
bacteria extends from sublethal to lethal effects. cation in an entrained gas flow. This is the com-
Sublethal effects cause bacteriostatic changes, monly used technology in plasma wands current-
while lethal effects cause bacteriocidal changes. ly used in
coblation surgical procedures.
Growth of drug resistant bacteria MRSA in 3. Hybrid plasma - combines the technique of
hospital environment poses a great challenge in both direct plasma and indirect plasma. Ground-
sterilization efforts. Ideal sterilization mechanism ed wire mesh electrode is used for this purpose.
should be fast and efficient. Studies reveal that
plasma devices perform this action rather effort- A broad spectrum of plasma sources dedicated
lessly. for biomedical applications have been developed.
524
1. Strong electrical field
2. Shock mechanical wave
3. Free radical production
4. Strong UV radiation
5. Production of ozone if oxygen is present in the
system
Plasma:
Image showing coblator wand with three elec-
The effectiveness of coblation technology is due trodes separated by ceramic
to the formation of plasma. Chemically speaking
plasma is a form of ionized gas. The term ionized For effective use of this technology for surgical
indicate the presence of at least one unbound procedures the plasma generated by the wand /
electron. The presence of electrons and ions electrode should be uniform. The uniformity of
makes plasma an electrically conductive media plasma can be ensured by:
better than copper or gold.
1. Increasing pre ionization of the gas thus ensur-
Plasmas are generated by electrical discharges in ing generation of more avalanches
direct contact with liquids. Electric underwater 2. Shortening of voltage rise time
discharges create the following phenomena:
526
These highly energized ions form a plasma field
strong enough to break organic molecular bonds
within soft tissue causing its dissolution. Since
1950’s high frequency electrosurgical apparatus
have been in use. In conventional high frequen-
cy apparatus heat is made use of to cause tissue
ablation and coagulation. The heat generated
happens to be a double edged weapon causing
collateral damage to normal tissues. Coblation is Image of RF generator
actually a beneficial offshoot of high frequency
radio frequency energy. The excellent conduc-
tivity of saline is made use of in this technology. Effect of plasma on tissue:
This conductivity is responsible for high energy
plasma generation. The effect of plasma on tissue is purely chemical
and not thermal. Plasma generates H and OH
Stages of plasma generation: ions. It is these ions that make plasma destructive.
OH radical causes protein degradation. When
First stage – (Vapor gas piston formation): coblation is being used to perform surgery the
This is characterised by transition from bubble interface between plasma and dissected tissue acts
to film boiling. This decreases heat emission and as a gate for charged particles.
causes increase in surface temperature. In nutshell coblation causes low temperature
molecular disintegration. This causes volumetric
Second stage – Stage of vapor film pulsation: Tis- removal of tissue with minimal damage to adja-
sue ablation occurs during this stage. cent tissue 10. (Collateral damage is low).
Third stage – Reduction of amplitude of current
across the electrodes.
Differences between coblation and conventional
Fourth stage : Dissipation of electron energy electrosurgical devices:
at the metal electrode surface Fifth stage (stage
of thermal dissipation of energy): This stage is Coblation Electrosurgi-
essentially due to recombination of plasma ions, devices cal devices
active atoms and molecules. Temperature 40-70 degrees 400-600 de-
Centigrade grees centi-
These stages explain why coblation is effective grade
if applied intermittently. This ensures constant
Thermal pen- Minimal Deep
presence of stage of vapor film pulsation which is
etration
important for tissue ablation.
Effects on Gentle re- Rapid heat-
target tissue moval/ disso- ing/charring/
lution burning/cut-
ting
Monopolar diathermy:
Bipolar diathermy:
Coblator:
Active and return electrodes are housed in the
same shaft.
RF generator:
528
7. Kashima’s procedure for bilateral abductor
This generator generates RF signals. It is con- paralysis
trolled by microprocessor. This generator is 8. Turbinate reduction
capable of adjusting the settings as per the type of 9. Nasal polypectomy
wand inserted. It automatically senses the type of 5. Cordectomy
the wand and adjusts settings accordingly. Man- 6. Removal of benign lesions of larynx including
ual override of the preset settings is also possible. papilloma
Two settings are set i.e. coblation and cauteriza- 7. Kashima’s procedure for bilateral abductor
tion. For a tonsil wand the recommended settings paralysis
would be : 8. Turbinate reduction
9. Nasal polypectomy
Coblation – 7 (plasma setting)
Cauterization – 3 (Non plasma setting) There are different types of wands 11 available to
perform coblation procedure optimally. Tonsil
Similarly the foot pedal has two color coded ped- and adenoid wand is the commonly used wand
als. Yellow one is for coblation and the blue one for all oropharyngeal surgeries. This wand will
is for RF cautery. This device also emits different have to be bent slightly to reach the
sounds when these pedals are pressed indicating adenoid. Laryngeal wand is of two types. Normal
to the surgeon which mode is getting activated. laryngeal wand which is used for ablating laryn-
geal mass lesions. Mini laryngeal wand is used to
Even though coblation is a type of electro sur- remove small polyps from vocal folds. The main
gical procedure, it does not require current flow advantage of mini laryngeal wand is its ability to
through the tissue to act. Only a small amount of reach up to the subglottic area.
current passes through the tissue during cobla-
tion. Nasal wand and nasal tunneling wands are
commonly used for turbinate reduction. Separate
Tissue ablation is made possible by the chemical tunneling wands are available for tongue base
etching effect of plasma generated by wand. The reduction.
thickness of plasma is only 100-200 μm thick
around the active electrode. Equipment specification:
Otolaryngological surgeries where coblation tech- 1. Modes of operation – Dissection, ablation, and
nology has been found to be useful include: coagulation
2. Operating frequency – 100 khz
1. Adenotonsillectomy 3. Power consumption – 110/240 v, 50/60 Khz
2. Tongue base reduction
3. Tongue channeling
4. Uvulo palato pharyngoplasty
5. Cordectomy
6. Removal of benign lesions of larynx including
papilloma
Coblation wand has two electrodes i.e. Base elec- between the electrodes. Hence a smoking wand
trode and active electrode. These electrodes are should be flushed using a syringe to remove soft
separated by ceramic. Saline flows between these tissue ablated particles between the electrodes.
two electrodes. Current generated flows between
these two electrodes via the saline medium. Sa- The generated frequency from coblator should at-
line gets broken down into ions thereby forming least be 200 kHz since frequencies lower than 100
active plasma which ablates tissue. kHz can cause neuromuscular excitation when
Efficiency of ablation can be improved by: the wand accidentally comes into contact with
neuromuscular tissue.
1. Intermittent application of ablation mode
2. Copious irrigation of normal saline Coblator has been designed to operate in two
3. By using cold saline plasma generated becomes different modes:
more efficient in ablating tissue. Cold saline can
be prepared by placing the saline pack in a refrig- Ablation mode: As the RF controller setting is
erator over night. increased from 1 to 9 in the coblation mode, the
performance of the wand transitions from ther-
Coblation is a smokeless procedure. If smoke is mal effect to ablative effect due to creation and
seen to be generated during the procedure it in- increase in the intensity of plasma. When the
dicates the presence of ablated tissue in the wand controller setting in the coblation mode increases
530
the plasma field increases in size and the thermal
effect decreases accordingly. Controller Unit:
Coagulation mode: All coblation wands have This is nothing but a Radio frequency generator.
been designed to operate in coagulation mode This unite generates RF signals. It is controlled
for hemostasis during surgery. Since the wand by a microprocessor chip. This unit is capable of
is bipolar in nature, it sends energy through the adjusting settings according to the type of wand
desired tissue area, through resistive heating inserted. It has also features of manual over ride
process. of automatic settings.
1. Coblation setting
2. Coagulation setting
3. Wand port
4. Foot pedal port
5. Flow control unit port
6. Hazard lamp
532
4. For using wands along with saline irrigation, Saline should only drip when the surgeon steps
the flow control valve unit is clamped to the IV on the pedal. Non stop flow of saline through the
stand. 500ml / 1000 ml normal saline is hung at wand indicates that the saline tube has not prop-
a height of 3 feet above the patient for ensuring erly passed through the pinch cock valve of the
optimal saline flow. flow control unit.
5. Plug one end of the flow control cable into the
rear of flow control valve unit, and the other end 8. Connect the OR suction tubing to the suc-
into the receptacle on the front of the controller. tion tubing of the wand. Recommended suction
6. Connect the IV tubing from the saline bottle pressure should ideally be between 250-300 mm
to the wand after passing through the pinch valve of Hg.
of the flow control unit. Valve switch is pressed
upwards so that green light is illuminated to open During surgery the tip of the wand emits a glow
the pinch valve. which is known as the plasma. Plasma generation
7. Open the irrigation tubing roller clamp to is necessary for tissue ablation. The color of the
manually start the saline flow. The saline can glow is dependent on the type of medium used.
be seen coming out of the tip of the wand. The Use of sodium chloride (Normal saline) solution
drip rate is adjusted by using the roller clamp of as the medium causes yellow colored
IV tube to the desired level. The valve switch is glow (plasma) while potassium chloride medium
pressed down to auto position. causes pinkish blue plasma glow.
seen turning brown. This does not indicate heat that emitted when the coagulate pedal is pressed.
induced charring but tissue oxidation. Surgeon who regularly use this equipment for
surgery could just by listening to the sound emit-
ted by the alarm on pressing either of these pedals
During surgery copious irrigation with normal will know which is being pressed just by hearing
saline increases the quality of plasma generat- the sound.
ed. Sometimes if the quantity of saline irritation
needs to be increased for better ablation of tissue.
In this scenario the flow can be increased by ap-
plying direct pressure to the saline bag.
534
Wands
1. Tonsil wand
2. Laryngeal wand
3. Microlaryngeal wand
4. Nasal wand
5. Needle wands for tongue base reduction and
turbinate reduction
Tonsil wands:
EVac T&A:
EVAC 70 XTRA:
536
* The shaft is also malleable hence it can be bent variations of the patient’s oropharynx.
confirming to the varying oropharyngeal anato-
my of the patient.
Image showing the ports and electrodes of EVAC Excise Pdw Plasma wand:
70 XTRA wand
This is considered by many surgeons to be a fine
Procise Max wand: dissecting instrument which delivers the effect of
coblation with the tactile feel of monopolar
This wand is suited for rapid ablation of tissue cautery. By design it has a single wire-loop elec-
with good hemostasis. This wand is particularly trode, with thinner and smaller shaft length
useful during adenoidectomies where rapid abla- which facilitates better surgical field visualisation.
tion of tissue with adequate hemostasis is a must.
It has a flat screen electrode configuration with Advantages of Excise Pdw Plasma wand:
high power suction port. Its ablation is about 20%
more than that of EVAC 70 Ultra. Its improved 1. It is a fine dissector, hence excellent surgical
suction capability prevents clogging of the wand plane can be created and maintained.
by ablated tissue. This wand is slightly thinner 2. Depth of thermal injury is less
than that of EVAC 70 wand thereby provides im- 3. Coagulation mode is useful to coagulate bleed-
proved visibility during surgeries. Since it is also ers
malleable it can be bent to confirm to anatomical 4. Its integrated suction and irrigation features
These wands are used for turbinate reduction sur- Image showing Reflex Ultra PTR wand
geries. These wands are designed to suit varying
anatomy of nasal turbinates. It is thin and sleek.
538
Technical specifications:
This is also a soft palate wand. This wand also has Image of PROcize EZ View wand
a distal ablative electrode and proximal thermal
electrode. This wand can also be used for chan- Default settings:
neling procedures of soft palate.
Coblate - 7
It is bent at 55 degrees which follows the curva- Coag - 3
ture of soft palate.
Coblation assisted nasal polypectomy is associat-
Default setting of this wand is: ed with a significant reduction in blood loss when
compared to that of debridement. Coblation
Coblate - 4 Assisted FESS (CAFESS) is a new technique of
Coagulate - 2 treatment for chronic sinusitis and nasal polypi.
It is currently holding out lots of promise. Lim-
PROcise EZ View wand: itations of coblator in nasal surgeries is largely
caused by the size of the wand and the saline
This wand is used for nasal surgeries. This wand delivery system. Increasing the amount of irriga-
offers all the benefits of coblation technology in a tion delivered will improve the efficiency of the
small diameter device. This wand integrates abla- system. The shaft width of PROcise EZ view wand
540
is 50% less than that of Evac 70 wand. To improve
irrigation 1 litre saline bag should be used.
PROcise LW:
542
my is caused due to spasm involving pharyngeal
Coblation Tonsillectomy: musculature. This is avoided if dissection stays
away from the capsule.
Introduction:
Coblation tonsillectomy is performed under
Currently coblation is being attempted to re- general anesthesia. Patient is put in Rose position
move tonsillar tissue. This process was invented (the same position that is used for conventional
by Philip E Eggers and Hira V Thapliyal in 1999. tonsillectomy). Operating microscope is used for
Coblation tonsillectomy received FDA approval visualisation. Lowest magnification is chosen.
in 2001.
Advantages of performing coblation tonsillecto-
Advantages of coblation tonsillectomy: my under magnification:
544
Incision is made just medial to the anterior pillar.
Ablation can start either from lower pole to upper
pole or from upper pole to lower pole according
to the preference of the surgeon. The process of
ablation should be uniform and the wand should
stay close to the tonsillar tissue and away from the
capsule to prevent damage to it. If ablation is not
uniform then the surgeon will end up digging a
pit in the tonsillar tissue and also will encounter
more bleeding than envisaged.
Post operative secondary bleeding is common in Image showing Tonsillotomy (Tonsillar debulk-
coblation tonsillectomy when compared with that ing surgery) being performed
of conventional cold steel method. Bleeding is not
torrential but blood tinged saliva could be seen in While performing tonsillotomy the wand should
some patients during the second week following be in contact with the tissue, hence there is always
surgery. This is due to the formation of granula- the risk of wand getting clogged with debris and
tion tissue, which is part of the healing process. hence need to be declogged by flushing with a
syringe. Clogging can be reduced if the flow of
saline is increased. Author prefers to over ride the
546
auto mode of the irrigation system to manual and dered breathing in children. Majority of these
seeking the help of assistant to compress / squeeze disorders have been attributed to adenoid hyper-
the saline bag while performing the surgery. trophy. Large number of these patients undergo
Suction used during tonsillotomy procedure adenoidectomy alone or a combination of ade-
should be reasonably powerful so that there is no noidectomy and tonsillectomy.
unnecessary accumulation of fluid and debris in
the surgical field. Various methods of performing adenoidectomy
include:
Advantages of Tonsillotomy:
1. Conventional cold steel technique using ade-
1. Post operative pain is less noid curette
2. Child’s immunity is not compromised at least 2. Bipolar coagulation under endoscopic vision
theoretically 3. Adenoidectomy using microdebrider
4. Coblation adenoidectomy
Disadvantages of coblation:
Adenoid hypertrophy has a tendency to recur af-
1. Cost of wand is high. ter surgery. The recurrence rate has been found to
2. It can be used only once because secondary in- be highly variable between studies. Lundgren’s se-
fections / secondary bleeding following coblation ries put the recurrence rate between 4-8%, while
surgery using already used wand is high. Hill’s series showed a variation between 23.7-50%.
3. Reuse of wands should be discouraged because
plasma generation is not optimal when wands are Tolczynski (1955) attributed the variations in
reused. recurrence rates between different studies to the
following factors:
Coblation Adenoidectomy
1. Anatomical difficulties
Introduction: 2. Adenoid area is difficult to visualize
3. Adenoidectomy is often performed in a hurry,
Adenoidectomy is one of the most commonly sometimes under inadequate anesthesia. This
performed surgeries in children. Complications causes inadequate relaxation of palato-pharyn-
following adenoidectomy is fortunately rare. geus muscles interfering with surgical manipula-
Various surgical techniques have been devised to tion of adenoid pad
improve the outcome of tissue.
following adenoidectomy, and to reduce bleeding
during the procedure. Operating surgeon should Adequate removal of hypertrophied adenoid
lay emphasis on the safety, accuracy and outcome tissue is difficult using conventional currettage in
of the procedure before deciding on the surgical the following scenario:
technique. 1. When there is intranasal extension of adenoid
tissue.
During the past decade there has been an increase 2. Bipolar coagulation under endoscopic vision
i n awareness of high prevalence of sleep disor- 3. Adenoidectomy using microdebrider
Adenoid hypertrophy has a tendency to recur af- Coblation adenoidectomy is currently becoming
ter surgery. The recurrence rate has been found to popular because:
be highly variable between studies. Lundgren’s se- 1. It facilitates complete removal of adenoid tissue
ries put the recurrence rate between 4-8%, while under direct vision
Hill’s series showed a variation between 23.7-50%. 2. Bleeding is very minimal
3. Every area of the nasopharynx is accessible to
Tolczynski (1955) attributed the variations in the wand tip
recurrence rates between different studies to the 4. Lower incidence of left over residual adenoid
following factors: tissue
5. Lower risk of complications
1. Anatomical difficulties Coblation adenoidectomy can be performed un-
2. Adenoid area is difficult to visualize der direct vision by using an endoscope through
3. Adenoidectomy is often performed in a hurry, the nasal cavity / endoscope (angled) via throat
sometimes under inadequate anesthesia. This after retracting the soft palate.
causes inadequate relaxation of palato-pharyn-
geus muscles interfering with surgical manipula- The Procedure:
tion of adenoid pad
of tissue. Coblation adenoidectomy is performed under
general anesthesia. Author prefers to perform
Adequate removal of hypertrophied adenoid tis- tonsillectomy before adenoidectomy if coblation
sue is difficult using conventional curettage in the technique is used because the same wand used for
following scenario: tonsillectomy can be bent to perform adenoidec-
1. When there is intranasal extension of adenoid tomy thereby cutting down on wand cost. Evac 70
tissue. is preferred by the author for adenoidectomy. If
2. Bulky mass of adenoid tissue superiorly in the difficulties are encountered in reaching the roof
nasopharynx of nasopharynx the wand can be bent appropri-
3. Adenoid tissue in the peritubal region ately. Wand can be bent at the junction of anterior
In the light of above stated facts, to ensure com- and middle thirds.
plete or near complete removal of adenoid tissue,
direct / indirect visual assistance is mandatory. After completion of tonsillectomy under Rose
position, the tonsillar jack is removed. Sand bag
Recent study by Ezaat 2010 demonstrated that under the shoulder is also removed. Patient’s head
when routine endoscopic examination of na- is elevated to 30 degrees. (Head up position as
sopharynx was performed after conventional in nasal surgeries). If the nasal cavity is roomy
adenoidectomy about 14.5% of patients demon- enough the wand can be inserted along with the
strated residual adenoid tissue which was needed nasal endoscope through the nasal cavity and the
to be removed. He thus went on to conclude that surgery is performed. In the event of a narrow
routine endoscopic examination of nasopharynx nasal cavity the wand can be inserted through the
following adenoidectomy clearly reduced the in- mouth after retracting the soft palate using soft
548
rubber catheter passing through the nasal cavi- conventional adenoidectomy. Copious irrigation
ty. Nasopharynx can be visualised using a nasal of saline ensures adequate plasma generation for
endoscope passed through the nasal cavity or by tissue ablation. Currently Procise Max wand has
passing an angled endoscope through the oral been promoted as a better tool for coblation ade-
cavity under the soft palate. noidectomy by the manufacturer.
Wand can be used to ablate adenoid tissue. Ade- Advantages of Procise Max wand according to
noid tissue is ablated till muscles of the posterior manufacturer are:
wall of nasopharynx is exposed. The movement of
the wand while performing adenoid tissue abla- 1. Tissue ablation is rapid because of the unique
tion resembles that of removing cobweb in the flat screen electrode
roof of a room. Irrigation should be copious while 2. Suction port in this wand is also very effective.
ablating adenoid tissue as there is a risk of wand According to the manufacturer ablation rate of
getting clogged with ablated tissue. The risk of procise wand is about50% faster than that of con-
wand clogging is higher during adenoid ablation ventional Evac 70 wands.
because the wand is in direct contact with the
tissue.
550
During surgery saline irrigation should be pro-
fuse. Recommended suction pressure should be Process of ablation should stop as soon as prever-
between 250-350 mm Hg. tebral fascia is reached. It can be identified by its
white color. Care must be taken not to damage
Coblation adenoidectomy is getting popular underlying prevertebral muscles. If bleeding is
because hither to blind procedure is now be- encountered it should be immediately cauterized
ing performed under direct vision. In coblation by using coagulation mode.
adenoidectomy tubal tonsil and adenoid tissue
around torus tubaris can be ablated with reason- Disadvantages of coblation adenoidectomy:
able confidence without fear of injury to
eustachean tube because it is being done under 1. Cost involved is high
direct vision. 2. Operating time is more when compared to
conventional adenoidectomy
For purposes of classification and management 3. Author encountered significant secondary
adenoid hypertrophy has been graded according bleeding following coblation adenoidectomy in
to the size of the tissue and its relationship with one patient. Post nasal pack and hospitalization
vomer, soft palate and torus tubaris. was needed before the patient recovered.
Introduction:
552
4. Neurological disorders - 15% airway is not adequate then the same procedure
5. Extralaryngeal malignancies 5-17% may also be repeated on the opposite side also.
For centuries tracheostomy was the treatment of Reker and Rudert modified Kashima’s procedure
choice for these patients. Even now all the exist- by a complementary resection in the body of
ing procedures are compared with that of tra- lateral thyroarytenoid muscle anteriorly from the
cheostomy. Tracheostomy hence still remains the initial triangular incision. This procedure enabled
gold standard against which all other treatment creation of better airway without compromising
modalities for bilateral abductor voice quality.
paralysis is compared. In 1922 Chevalier Jackson
introduced the procedure ventriculocordectomy
as a treatment procedure for bilateral abductor
paralysis. Major advantage of this procedure is
that it created
an excellent airway, but the voice became a bit
breathy because of excessive air leak while speak-
ing. In 1939 King proposed extralaryngeal aryte-
noidectomy.
Surgical Procedure:
554
Images showing steps of Kashima procedure
Ventricular band should be spared during the tages of this procedure.
surgery. Damage of ventricular bands could cause Author has performed 30 cases of coblation
unacceptable voice changes in a patient who un- Kashima procedure. All of them were successfully
dergoes this treatment. decannulated and weaned off the tracheosto-
my tube. Three year follow up of these patients
This enlarged posterior glottic space helps in im- showed no evidence of airway compromise.
proving the airway without compromising voice
quality. Since the anterior 2/3 of the vocal fold is Which cord to operate?
preserved, voice quality is usually good in these
patients. Bilateral abductor paralysis is a bilateral condi-
tion. Either of the two cords may be subjected to
Early decannulation: posterior cordotomy. Author believes the follow-
ing criteria could be used to decide which cord to
All these patients should be decannulated at the operate on.
earliest. It is preferable to spiggot the tracheosto-
my tube on the first post operative day itself.
This would facilitate natural airflow through the
glottis causing wound to heal better and faster.
This is infact one of the most important advan-
Conclusion:
1. Bloodless ablation
2. Precise ablation of tissue
3. No collateral damage to adjacent tissue
4. No oedema to tissues around larynx
5. Early decannulation is possible
556
Endoscopic cordectomy 3. Bilateral abductor paralysis
Hoover modified the procedure described by This procedure involves resection of vocal fold
Chevalier Jackson by approaching the vocal cords epithelium, Reinke’s space and vocal ligament.
via laryngofissure. Dissection was submucosal. This procedure is performed by cutting between
Major advantage of this procedure is the availabil- vocal ligament and vocalis muscle. Vocalis muscle
ity of adequate mucosa for primary closure of the is preserved as much as possible. Extent of resec-
surgical wound. tion extends from vocal process to the anterior
commissure.
Indications of vocal fold cordectomy:
Indications for type II cordectomy:
1. Vocal fold dysplasia
2. T1 malignant lesions of vocal fold 1. In patients with severe vocal fold leukoplakia
558
Image showing Type II cordectomy (Subligamental cordectomy)
560
Va).
562
2. Less expensive
3. Preserves voice and other protective functions
of larynx
Procedure:
564
tumor mass. Dissection should follow this plane
till the entire mass is removed. Inorder to develop
a plane the mass should be medialised using a
cup forceps.
566
Juvenile Papilloma of larynx:
Role of coblation in benign laryngeal lesions
This condition occurs in infants and children.
Classic features of juvenile papilloma larynx
Coblation is of immense value in the manage- include:
ment of benign lesions involving the larynx. 1. Multiple in nature
Obvious advantages of this technology being that 2. Aggressive in its behavior
it ablates tissue without abnormally increasing the 3. Known to recur after successful surgical re-
surface temperature. moval
4. Commonly caused by Human papilloma virus
There is hence absolutely nil risk of airway fire type 6 / type 1.
during the procedure. This technology has been 5. Infants get infected from infected mother’s
effectively used to treat the following laryngeal genitals during delivery
lesions:
This type of papilloma is frequently localised in
1. Papilloma of larynx the larynx. This condition can also undergo spon-
2. Laryngeal web taneous remissions.
4. Cysts involving epiglottis
5. Benign vocal fold lesions like cysts / hemangio- Clinical features:
mas / nodules.
1. Hoarseness of voice
Papilloma of larynx 2. Child may have difficulty while crying
3. When the masses enlarge in size airway com-
Introduction: promise has been known to occur causing stridor.
Papilloma larynx usually involves vocal cords, This is a small DNA containing non enveloped,
false cords and epiglottis. These masses are friable icosohedral (20 sided) capsid virus. The DNA
and bleed on touch. It usually occurs in two inside the iron is double stranded and circular.
forms:
1. Juvenile papilloma
2. Adult papilloma
568
subglottic area.
This virus is also capable of inactivating retino-
blastoma tumor suppressor protein (pRB). It is Since there is very little damage to adjacent tissue,
also known to cause degradation of TIP60 which tissue oedema is also reduced. There is no threat
is involved in the activation of apoptosis, enabling of airway compromise due to tissue oedema as is
the infected cell to survive longer and to replicate. the case with laser. Infact laser vaporization caus-
These viruses are also known to cause degra- es delayed oedema after a week / 10 days com-
dation of p130 which activates cell division by promising the airway, hence patients need to be
pushing cells in phase G0 to G1. hospitalized and kept under observation during
this period.
Ki67 expression is an important marker for mi-
totic activity which detects all stages of mitosis If possible it is better to avoid tracheostomy in
except G0 phase. Studies reveal that there is sig- these patients because papillomas have a tenden-
nificant correlation between the level of expres- cy to recur around tracheostomy stoma. If airway
sion of Ki67 and recurrence / malignant transfor- is not compromised, then care should be taken to
mation of respiratory papillomatosis. carefully intubate the patient under direct visual-
ization using CMac video laryngoscope. Intuba-
Role of coblation in surgical management of tion under vision causes less trauma and hence
laryngeal papillomatosis: less bleeding during intubation in these patients.
570
Standard cuffed microlaryngeal endotracheal Procedure:
tubes would suffice. For additional protection wet
cottonoids can be placed gently around the cuff. If To facilitate ablation the tip of microlaryngeal
needed jet ventilation can also be used along with wand should be held as close to the target tissue
this device. as possible. Care should be taken while ablating
to spare the adjacent normal tissue. The ablate
Procedure: pedal (yellow) should be pressed briefly for about
1-2 seconds for ablation to occur.
Patient is intubated using a microlaryngeal endo- The process of ablation is continued briefly by
tracheal tube. pressing the yellow pedal for allowing tissue di-
gestion at the tip of the electrode.
Features of Microlaryngeal endotracheal tube:
Image showing laryngeal wand being used to Image showing the vocal fold after removal of
ablate angioma vocal fold angioma
572
but rather common in adults. It is highly prev-
Advantages of coblation in microlaryngeal sur- alent in atopic individuals. Clinically lingual
geries: tonsillar enlargement is not commonly appreciat-
ed during routine clinical examination. It needs a
1. Damage to adjacent normal tissue is minimal discerning eye for
or negligible routine identification. Many of these patients are
2. Mucosal surface of vocal folds heal rather asymptomatic.
quickly as evidenced by the return of normal
mucosal wave pattern within 6 weeks following Rarely enlarged lingual tonsils can cause:
surgery
3. There is absolutely zero risk of airway fire 1. Globus sensation
4. There is absolutely negligible bleeding during 2. Change in voice
surgery 3. Chronic cough
5. Healing is rapid because formation of exudate 4. Choking attacks
is rather minimal 5. Dyspnoea (rare)
6. Even bilateral vocal fold lesions can be ad- 6. Sore throat (acute phase)
dressed in the same sitting because the risk of web 7. Leukocytosis (acute phase)
formation is rather minimal because of reduced 8. Abscess formation
exudate formation 9. Obstructive sleep apnoea
7. Anterior commissure lesions can be addressed 10 Recurrent acute epiglottitis
without fear of blunting Blood supply of lingual tonsil 2
:
Arterial:
Role of coblation in Lingual tonsillectomy Ascending pharyngeal
Dorsal branch of lingual artery
Introduction: Venous drainage: Is via the plexus of veins present
in the tongue base
Lingual tonsils are normal components of Wal-
dayer’s ring. This is a collection of lymphoid Lymphatic drainage:
tissue located at the base of tongue. They are two
in number situated posterior to the circumvallate Lymphatics from lingual tonsil drain into sup-
papillae of the tongue. They lie just anterior to the rahyoid, sub maxillary and upper deep cervical
vallecula. Lingual tonsils are divided in the mid- group of nodes.
line by the presence of median glosso epiglottic
ligament. Lingual tonsil tissue rests on the base- Innervation:
ment membrane of fibrous tissue which could
be considered analogous to tonsillar capsule of Glossopharyngeal nerve
palatine tonsil. Superior laryngeal branch of vagus nerve
Hypertrophy of this lymphoid tissue are rare in Causes of lingual tonsil hypertrophy:
children 1. Compensatory hypertrophy following adenoid-
574
tion. Lingual musculature is hence left intact even
after complete removal of lingual tonsillar tissue.
Since lingual musculature is left undisturbed, post
operative pain is less than that of other proce-
dures.
Tip:
576
Image showing edges of the resected tongue base
sutured
Image showing Evac 70 tonsillar wand being
used Coblation assisted Lewis and MacKay operation:
Image showing sectioning of the marked area in Tongue channelling can be combined with tongue
the posterior third of the tongue base resection.
Ablation causes fibrosis of lingual musculature Image showing Tongue channelling done in the
thereby cause reduction in the tongue bulk. Cur- anterior portion of lateral border of tongue
rently available reflex ultra wands are provided
with saline irrigation facility. If older version of
these wands are used
then saline should be infiltrated into the area
before ablation is commenced.
578
This procedure can be performed under local
anesthesia. Reflex Ultra 55 wand is used for this
procedure. Seven channels should be created in
the tongue for channelling purpose. These chan-
nels include:
580
Coblation in Uvulopalatopharyngoplasty
Introduction:
1. Complete removal of uvula and distal palate Figure showing Tonsillectomy being performed
2. Removal of part of palatopharyngeus muscle with preservation of pillar mucosa
and use of uvulopalatal flap
3. Use of coblation to perform UPPP
4. Laser assisted uvulopalatoplasty
582
Pillar suturing: Robinson modified uvulopalatopharyngoplasty:
Suturing both anterior and posterior pillars Major advantage of this procedure is that it opens
together is the next step. This should be done on the lateral velopharyngeal ports. In this procedure
both sides. only the tonsils and submucosal fat are resected.
This should indeed be considered as reconstruc-
tive surgery and not ablation.
584
Malignant tumor of oropharynx Ablation using
Coblator
Introduction:
Regional Nodes:
586
Metastasis:
M0 - No distant metastasis
M1 - Distant metastasis is present
588
genesis of Rhinophyma.
Rhinophyma Excision Role of Coblation
Stage II:
Introduction: Increased vascularity leads to this stage char-
acterised by thickened skin, telengiectasis with
The term Rhinophyma originates from the Greek persistent facial oedema (erythrosis). A small
term “rhis” meaning nose and “phyma” mean- number of these patients may progress to the next
ing growth. 1 This condition is characterised by stage.
thickening of skin over the nose due to soft tissue
hypertrophy. This condition is 5 times more com- Stage III:
mon in males than in females. This is very rarely This stage is the stage of acne rosacea. Features of
seen in children. This condition is considered as this stage include:
end stage
of sebaceous overgrowth and scarring from poor- 1. Erythematous papules
ly controlled acne rosacea. This condition is also 2. Pustules over forehead, glabella, malar region,
referred by the term “W.C. Fields nose”. This con- nose and chin Pustules can sometimes be seen in
dition is characterised typically by hypertrophic other areas like chest, scalp (bald areas).
nodular growths in the distal half of the nose.
The nose hence becomes ultimately fibrous and According to Wilkins these stages can also be
inflammed. The color of the skin usually changes called as prerosacea, vascular rosacea and inflam-
to deep red / purple due to the presence of diffuse matory rosacea.
telengiactesis.
Stage IV:
Virchow has been credited for having correctly This is the classic rhinophyma. Patients who go
associating rhinophyma with acne rosacea in on to reach this stage is rather small. Nose is the
1846. Even though acne rosacea is common in most common site affected.
women, progression to facial skin thickening
and Rhinophyma is common in men. This could Other sites involved include:
probably be attributed to androgen influence.
Zygophyma - zygomatic area
Clinical features: Mentophyma - Mental area
Otophyma - involving the pinna
Rebora’s description of various stages of Rhino-
phyma: Gross appearance:
Nasal skin appears erythematous with telengiec-
Stage I: tasis. The skin may
sometimes appear purple in color. In severe cases
This stage is characterized by frequent episodes the skin over the nose can have pits, fissures and
of facial flushing. According to Wilkin Rosacea areas of scarring. Inspissated sebum and bacterial
is essentially a cutaneous vascular disorder hence infection in these areas could cause foul odor to
flushing happens to be the first stage in the patho- emit in these patients. Nasal tip area is preferen-
Mark’s hypothesis 8 regarding genesis of rhino- Wiemer suggested that facial flushing which is
phyma: a feature of Rhinophyma could be due to con-
sumption of vasoactive foods and drinks (which
a. Vascular instability in the skin include alcohol) could be a coincidence and not
b. Loss of fluid into the dermal insterstitium and an etiological factor.
matrix
c. Inflammation and fibrosis Bacterial colonization along with plugged seba-
590
ceous glands have been consistently demonstrat- who provide history of worsening rosacea with
ed in patients with acne rosacea. This prompted their hormonal cycle
Anderson to postulate a link between Demodex 9. Dapsone can also be used to treat severe and
Folliculorum and acne rosacea in 1932. Focus on refractory forms of rosacea
infective etiology as a causative factor for rhin- 10 Tacrolimus ointment: It reduces itching and
opyma still continues, Helicobacter Pylori has inflammation by suppressing the release of cyto-
been implicated because many of these patients kines from T cells.
complained of gastrointestinal disturbances. The 11. Tetracycline and Doxicycline can be used as
current consensus is that this hypothesis has no antibiotics in these patients
scientific merit. Cutaneous malignancies can go
unnoticed in these patients. Role of surgery:
Squamous cell carcinoma, sebaceous carcinoma Surgery is indicated in severe cases of rhinophy-
and angiosarcoma have been reported in these ma not responding
patients. to conventional medical therapy. The lesion is ex-
cised taking care to preserve perichondrium. Raw
Management: area can be reconstructed using full thickness
skin graft. Preservation of perichondrium goes a
Aggressive management of acne rosacea may go long way in preventing scar formation. Excision
a long way in reducing the incidence of rhino- of the lesion can be performed using carbondiox-
phyma in these patients. Currently oral / topical ide laser / scalpel excision / dermabrasion / Weck
antibiotics and retenoids are the main stay in razor excision. Currently coblation technology
managing these patients. is being attempted with good results. This proce-
dure in addition to providing excellent bleeding
1. Regular facial massage: This helps in the reduc- control causes very little collateral damage there-
tion of facial oedema. by reducing scar tissue formation.
2. Avoidance of consumption of too hot / too cold
drinks
3. Avoidance of alcohol
4. Topical use of metronidazole (first line of man-
agement)
5. Topical azelaic acid (known to reduce bacterial
colonization and decreased production of kera-
tin)
6. Topical apha 2 agonist Brimonidine can be
used to manage erythema associated with acne
rosacea
7. Topical ivermectin has been approved by FDA
for treatment of inflammatory lesions associated
with rosacea. Image showing the patient intubated and draped
8. Oral contraceptives can be used in patients
592
the development at the capillary network stage.
Role of coblation in the management of oro- Arrest of development during the second stage of
pharyngeal hemangioma development of vascular system (retiform stage)
may produce venous, arterial or capillary malfor-
Introduction: mations.
1. Capillary
2. Venocapillary
3. Venous
4. Lymphatic
5. Arterial
6. Mixed
594
Image showing hemangioma of posterior third of Image showing tonsil wand being used to ablate
tongue extending up to the pyriform fossa hemangioma
Rendo-Osler-Weber syndrome:
596
Due to the very small surface area at the point of
Diathermy the electrode, the current density at this point is
really high, producing a focal effect allowing the
Introduction: tissues to heat up rapidly. In monopolar diather-
my, since the current passes through the body, its
The word diathermy means “heating through” density decreases rapidly as the surface area the
refers to the production of heat by passing a high current acts across increases. This allows focused
frequency current through tissue. This term heating of tissues at the point of use, without
was coined in 1908 by the German physician heating up the body.
Karl Franz Nagelschemidt. In the medieval ages
haemostasis was sometimes achieved by red hot Types of diathermy:
stones or irons applied to the bleeding surface ( a
heroic and rather risky procedure). Configuration of the diathermy device can either
be monopolar or bipolar. Both actions require
The principle behind the use of diathermy in the electrical circuit to be completed, but vary
surgical practice is that it uses very high frequen- how this is actually achieved.
cies (0.5 - 3 MHz) of alternate polarity radio wave
electrical current to cut or to coagulate tissue Monopolar - In this mode of action, the electrical
during surgery. This allows diathermy to avoid current oscillates between the surgeon’s elec-
the frequencies used by body systems to generate trode, through the patient’s body, until it meets
electrical current, such as skeletal muscle and the grounding plate (positioned underneath the
cardiac tissue thereby allowing body physiology patient’s leg) to complete the circuit.
to be broadly unaffected during its use.
Bipolar - In this mode, the two electrodes are
It also allows for precise incisions to be made found on the instrument itself. The bipolar ar-
with limited blood loss and is used in nearly all rangement negates the need for dispersive elec-
surgical disciplines. Radio frequencies generat- trodes, instead a pair of similar sized electrodes
ed by the diathermy heat the tissue to allow for are used in tandem. The current is then passed
cutting and coagulation, by creating intracellular between the electrodes.
oscillation of molecules within the cells. Depend-
ing on the temperature generated different results Bipolar is commonly used in surgery involv-
could be achieved: ing digits, in patients with pacemakers to avoid
electrical interference with the pacemaker and in
60 degree centigrade - cell death occurs (fulgura- microsurgery to catch bleeders.
tion)
598
three patterns of current flow:
RF cautery:
1. Fully rectified, filtered and is used mainly for
Also known as radio frequency / high frequency incision (micro smooth cutting) 90% cutting and
cautery. This electrical system is used for tissue 10% coagulation.
reduction purposes like turbinate reduction.
2. Fully rectified, used mainly for excision of
The technique of RF cautery involves the passage epidermal growths (50% cutting and 50% coagu-
of high frequency radio waves (2mHz) through lation).
soft tissue to cut/coagulate/remove soft tissue.
The resistance offered by soft tissue to radio waves 3. Partially rectified, used mainly for hemostasis
causes the cellular water to heat leading on to or coagulating vascular lesions (90% coagulation
release of steam which results in dissolution of and 10% cutting).
individual cells. The surgeon uses a hand piece
with an active electrode (different types for differ- There is minimal collateral damage (about 75
ent surgical applications) to transmit radio waves. micrometer) caused by RF cautery. The possible
The radio waves are focused on the tissue by an reasons for minimal collateral damage are:
antenna plate (also known as the patient plate)
that is placed behind the tissue in contact with 1. The electrodes don’t get heated during the
the patient’s skin. procedure
A radio frequency unit converts the standard 2. Only the tip of the electrode comes into to con-
household current (60 cycles) to high frequency tact with the tissue and that too for a very short
range (3-4 MHz). This device has both cut and time.
coagulation modes making it an effective tool for
various surgical procedures. 3. The diameter of the electrode is pretty small
and hence the electrode tissue interface is also
Mechanism of action: small.
The radio waves created by this device travel from 4. It uses high frequency power but at very low
the electrode tip to the patient and are returned intensity.
to the device via an indifferent plate antenna
placed under the patient’s body in the vicinity of
the surgical site. The antenna may or may not
require direct contact with the skin depending on Advantages of radiosurgery:
the manufacturer’s instruction and design. As the
current passes through the tissues, impedance to 1. Less bleeding
the passage of current through the tissue gener-
ates heat, which boils the tissue water creating 2. Quicker operating time
steam resulting in either cutting or coagulating
the tissue. This device is capable of producing 3. Rapid healing
1. Turbinate debulking
2. Tonsillectomy
600
Suture Materials The type of suture material chose could vary de-
pending on the clinical scenario.
Months to n ever - vascular prosthesis Vicryl rapide - 42 days - This is the fastest absorb-
ing synthetic suture and is ideal for soft tissue ap-
At this point it should be stressed that regardless proximation, approximation of skin and mucosal
of the composition of the suture, the body will re- wounds where only short term wound support is
act to it as a foreign body and goes on to produce all that is needed. It is available in 5 sizes.
a fb type of reaction which could vary in severity.
Vicryl - 60 days - This is made of polyglactin 910.
Classification of suture material: It is absorbable, synthetic and braided suture.
This suture material holds its tensile strength for
In broad terms wound sutures can be classified 2-3 weeks in tissue and is completely hydrolyzed
into absorbable and non-absorbable materials. within 70 days. A monofilament version of this
These material can further be sub classified into suture is used in ophthalmology.
synthetic / natural sutures, and monofilament or
multifilament sutures. Monocryl - 100 days - This is a synthetic absorb-
able suture which is made from poliglecaprone
Ideal suture material should be the smallest possi- 25. It comes in dyed (violet) as well as undyed
ble to produce uniform tensile strength, securely forms. This is a monofilament suture material.
hold the wound for the required time for healing It is generally used for soft tissue approximation
and then be absorbed. The response to the suture and ligation. It is used frequently for subcuticular
material should be predictable and easy to handle. dermis closures of the facial wound. This suture
It should evoke minimal tissue reaction and has material has a low tissue reactivity, it maintains
the ability to be knotted securely. high tensile strength. It has a high degree of
PDS - 200 days - This is a sterile, synthetic ab- Multifilament - This is made up of several fila-
sorbable monofilament suture material made ments that are twisted together (braided silk / vic-
from polyester. This material is ideal for general ryl). They are easy to handle and hold their shape
soft tissue approximation. This suture material for good knot security but can harbor infections.
is very useful where a combination of absorbable
sutures and extended wound support is desirable.
Type Ab- Non Mono- Mul-
Non absorbable sutures: sorb- absorb- fila- tifila-
able able ment ment
These are used to provide long term tissue sup- Vicryl
port, remaining walled-off by the body’s inflam-
matory processes until removed manually if PDS
required. Uses for this material include suturing
tissues that heal rather slowly (fascia, tendons and Mono
closure of abdominal wall) or also in performing cryl
vascular anastomosis. Nylon
602
Image showing different types of suture materials and their classification
It should also be as slim as possible to minimize A swaged end that connects the needle to the
trauma and sharp enough to penetrate tissue suture material.
without resistance / minimal resistance. It should
also be stable enough to be held with a needle A needle body or shaft which is the region
holder. grasped by the needle holder. The body of the
needle can be round, cutting or reverse cutting.
Common surgical needles are made of stainless
steel. They consist of: Round bodied needles are used in friable tissue.
604
Prof Dr Balasubramanian Thiagarajan